about summary refs log tree commit diff
path: root/Doc/Zsh
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
Diffstat (limited to 'Doc/Zsh')
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/.distfiles9
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/.lastloc1
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/arith.yo73
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/builtins.yo1184
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/compat.yo69
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/compctl.yo526
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/cond.yo158
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/exec.yo25
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/expn.yo1052
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/filelist.yo15
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/files.yo26
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/func.yo107
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/grammar.yo335
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/guide.yo149
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/index.yo24
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/intro.yo38
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/invoke.yo23
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/jobs.yo91
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/metafaq.yo142
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/mod_cap.yo28
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/mod_clone.yo19
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/mod_comp1.yo11
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/mod_compctl.yo7
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/mod_deltochar.yo12
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/mod_example.yo16
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/mod_files.yo100
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/mod_sched.yo17
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/mod_stat.yo145
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/mod_zftp.yo421
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/mod_zle.yo193
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/modules.yo64
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/options.yo1039
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/params.yo812
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/prompt.yo209
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/redirect.yo183
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/restricted.yo44
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/seealso.yo25
-rw-r--r--Doc/Zsh/zle.yo1076
38 files changed, 8468 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/.distfiles b/Doc/Zsh/.distfiles
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..42517f507
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/.distfiles
@@ -0,0 +1,9 @@
+DISTFILES_SRC='
+    .distfiles
+    arith.yo builtins.yo compat.yo compctl.yo cond.yo exec.yo expn.yo
+    filelist.yo files.yo func.yo grammar.yo guide.yo index.yo intro.yo
+    invoke.yo jobs.yo metafaq.yo mod_cap.yo mod_clone.yo mod_comp1.yo
+    mod_compctl.yo mod_deltochar.yo mod_example.yo mod_files.yo mod_sched.yo
+    mod_stat.yo mod_zle.yo modules.yo options.yo params.yo prompt.yo
+    redirect.yo restricted.yo seealso.yo zle.yo
+'
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/.lastloc b/Doc/Zsh/.lastloc
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..8b1a784a8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/.lastloc
@@ -0,0 +1 @@
+(("/home/user2/pws/src/zsh-3.1.5/Doc/Zsh/expn.yo" . 33735))
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/arith.yo b/Doc/Zsh/arith.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..1560c81d3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/arith.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,73 @@
+texinode(Arithmetic Evaluation)(Conditional Expressions)(Jobs & Signals)(Top)
+chapter(Arithmetic Evaluation)
+ifzman(\
+sect(Arithmetic Evaluation)
+)\
+cindex(arithmetic evaluation)
+cindex(evaluation, arithmetic)
+An ability to perform integer arithmetic is provided with the builtin tt(let).
+findex(let, use of)
+Evaluations are performed using em(long) arithmetic.
+A leading `tt(0x)' or `tt(0X)' denotes hexadecimal.
+Otherwise, numbers are of the form `[var(base)tt(#)]var(n)',
+where var(base) is a decimal number between two and thirty-six
+representing the arithmetic base and var(n)
+is a number in that base (for example, `tt(16#ff)' is 255 in hexadecimal).
+If var(base) is omitted
+then base 10 is used.  For backwards compatibility the form
+`tt([)var(base)tt(])var(n)' is also accepted.
+
+cindex(arithmetic operators)
+cindex(operators, arithmetic)
+An arithmetic expression uses nearly the same syntax, precedence, and
+associativity of expressions in C.
+The following operators are supported (listed in decreasing order
+of precedence):
+
+startsitem()
+sitem(tt(PLUS() - ! ~ PLUS()PLUS() --))(unary plus/minus, logical NOT, complement, {pre,post}{in,de}crement)
+sitem(tt(<< >>))(bitwise shift left, right)
+sitem(tt(&))(bitwise AND)
+sitem(tt(^))(bitwise XOR)
+sitem(tt(|))(bitwise OR)
+sitem(tt(**))(exponentiation)
+sitem(tt(* / %))(multiplication, division, modulus (remainder))
+sitem(tt(PLUS() -))(addition, subtraction)
+sitem(tt(< > <= >=))(comparison)
+sitem(tt(== !=))(equality and inequality)
+sitem(tt(&&))(logical AND)
+sitem(tt(|| ^^))(logical OR, XOR)
+sitem(tt(? :))(ternary operator)
+sitem(tt(= PLUS()= -= *= /= %= &= ^= |= <<= >>= &&= ||= ^^= **=))(assignment)
+sitem(tt(,))(comma operator)
+endsitem()
+
+The operators `tt(&&)', `tt(||)', `tt(&&=)', and `tt(||=)' are short-circuiting,
+and only one of the latter two expressions in a ternary operator
+is evaluated.  Note the precedence of the bitwise AND, OR,
+and XOR operators.
+
+An expression of the form `tt(#\)var(x)' where var(x) is any character
+gives the ascii value of this character and an expression of the form
+`tt(#)var(foo)' gives the ascii value of the first character of the value
+of the parameter var(foo).
+
+Named parameters and subscripted arrays can be referenced by name within an
+arithmetic expression without using the parameter substitution syntax.
+
+An internal integer representation of a named parameter
+can be specified with the tt(integer) builtin.
+cindex(parameters, integer)
+cindex(integer parameters)
+findex(integer, use of)
+Arithmetic evaluation is performed on the value of each
+assignment to a named parameter declared integer
+in this manner.
+
+Since many of the arithmetic operators require
+quoting, an alternative form of the tt(let) command is provided.
+For any command which begins with a tt(LPAR()LPAR()),
+all the characters until a matching tt(RPAR()RPAR())
+are treated as a quoted expression.
+More precisely, `tt(LPAR()LPAR()) ... tt(RPAR()RPAR())'
+is equivalent to `tt(let ")...tt(")'.
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/builtins.yo b/Doc/Zsh/builtins.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..8959543c5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/builtins.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,1184 @@
+texinode(Shell Builtin Commands)(Zsh Line Editor)(Options)(Top)
+chapter(Shell Builtin Commands)
+ifzman(\
+sect(Shell Builtin Commands)
+)\
+cindex(builtin commands)
+cindex(commands, builtin)
+def(prefix)(1)(\
+findex(ARG1)
+item(tt(ARG1) var(simple command))(
+See noderef(Precommand Modifiers).
+)\
+)\
+def(alias)(2)(\
+findex(ARG1)
+item(tt(ARG1))(
+Same as tt(ARG2).
+)\
+)\
+startitem()
+prefix(-)
+findex(.)
+item(tt(.) var(file) [ var(arg) ... ])(
+Read commands from var(file) and execute them in the current shell
+environment.
+If var(file) does not contain a slash, or if tt(PATH_DIRS)
+is set, the shell looks in the components of tt($path) to find the
+directory containing var(file).
+Files in the current directory are not read unless `tt(.)' appears
+somewhere in tt($path).
+
+If any arguments var(arg) are given,
+they become the positional parameters; the old positional
+parameters are restored when the var(file) is done executing.
+The exit status is the exit status of the last command executed.
+)
+findex(NOTRANS(:))
+cindex(expanding parameters)
+cindex(parameters, expanding)
+cindex(doing nothing)
+item(tt(:) [ var(arg) ... ])(
+This command only expands parameters.  A zero exit code is returned.
+)
+findex(alias)
+cindex(aliases, defining)
+cindex(aliases, listing)
+item(tt(alias) [ tt(-gmrL) ] [ var(name)[tt(=)var(value)] ... ])(
+For each var(name) with a corresponding var(value), define an alias
+with that value.  A trailing space in var(value) causes the next word
+to be checked for alias substitution.  If the tt(-g) flag is present,
+define a global alias; global aliases are expanded even if they do not
+occur in command position.
+
+For each var(name) with no var(value),
+print the value of var(name), if any.  With no arguments, print all
+currently defined aliases.  If the tt(-m) flag is given the arguments
+are taken as patterns (they should be quoted to preserve them from being
+interpreted as glob patterns), and the aliases matching these patterns
+are printed.  When printing aliases and the tt(-g) or tt(-r) flags
+are present, then restrict the printing to global or regular
+aliases, respectively.
+
+If the tt(-L) flag is present, then print each
+alias in a manner suitable for putting in a startup script.  The exit
+status is nonzero if a var(name) (with no var(value)) is given for
+which no alias has been defined.
+)
+findex(autoload)
+cindex(functions, autoloading)
+cindex(autoloading functions)
+alias(autoload)(functions -u)
+findex(bg)
+cindex(jobs, backgrounding)
+xitem(tt(bg) [ var(job) ... ])
+item(var(job) ... tt(&))(
+Put each specified var(job) in the background,
+or the current job if none is specified.
+)
+findex(break)
+cindex(exiting loops)
+cindex(loops, exiting)
+item(tt(break) [ var(n) ])(
+Exit from an enclosing tt(for), tt(while),
+tt(until), tt(select) or tt(repeat) loop.  If var(n)
+is specified, then break var(n) levels instead of just one.
+)
+findex(builtin)
+item(tt(builtin) var(name) [ var(args) ... ])(
+Executes the builtin var(name), with the given var(args).
+)
+alias(bye)(exit)
+findex(cd)
+cindex(directories, changing)
+xitem(tt(cd) [ tt(-sLP) ] [ var(arg) ])
+xitem(tt(cd) [ tt(-sLP) ] var(old) var(new))
+item(tt(cd) [ tt(-sLP) ] {tt(PLUS())|tt(-)}var(n))(
+Change the current directory.  In the first form, change the
+current directory to var(arg), or to the value of tt($HOME) if
+var(arg) is not specified.  If var(arg) is `tt(-)', change to the
+value of tt($OLDPWD), the previous directory.
+If a directory named var(arg) is not found in the current directory
+and var(arg) does not begin with a slash,
+search each component of the shell parameter tt(cdpath).
+If the option tt(CDABLE_VARS) is set, and a parameter named var(arg)
+exists whose value begins with a slash, treat its value as
+the directory.
+
+The second form of tt(cd) substitutes the string var(new)
+for the string var(old) in the name of the current directory,
+and tries to change to this new directory.
+
+The third form of tt(cd) extracts an entry from the directory
+stack, and changes to that directory.  An argument of the form
+`tt(PLUS())var(n)' identifies a stack entry by counting from the left
+of the list shown by the tt(dirs) command, starting with zero.
+An argument of the form `tt(-)var(n)' counts from the right.
+If the tt(PUSHD_MINUS) option is set, the meanings of `tt(PLUS())'
+and `tt(-)' in this context are swapped.
+
+If the tt(-s) option is specified, tt(cd) refuses to change the current
+directory if the given pathname contains symlinks.  If the tt(-P) option
+is given or the tt(CHASE_LINKS) option is set, symbolic links are resolved
+to their true values.  If the tt(-L) option is given symbolic links are
+followed regardless of the state of the tt(CHASE_LINKS) option.
+)
+alias(chdir)(cd)
+prefix(command)
+findex(continue)
+cindex(loops, continuing)
+cindex(continuing loops)
+item(tt(continue) [ var(n) ])(
+Resume the next iteration of the enclosing
+tt(for), tt(while), tt(until), tt(select) or
+tt(repeat) loop.  If var(n) is specified, break out of
+var(n)-1 loops and resume at the var(n)th enclosing loop.
+)
+alias(declare)(typeset)
+findex(dirs)
+cindex(directory stack, printing)
+item(tt(dirs) [ tt(-v) ] [ var(arg) ... ])(
+With no arguments, print the contents of the directory stack.
+If the tt(-v) option is given, number the directories
+in the stack when printing.
+Directories are added to this stack with the tt(pushd) command,
+and removed with the tt(cd) or tt(popd) commands.
+If arguments are specified, load them onto the directory stack,
+replacing anything that was there, and push the current directory
+onto the stack.
+)
+findex(disable)
+cindex(disabling commands)
+cindex(commands, disabling)
+item(tt(disable) [ tt(-afmr) ] var(name) ...)(
+Temporarily disable the var(name)d hash table elements.  The default
+is to disable builtin commands.  This allows you to use an external
+command with the same name as a builtin command.  The tt(-a) option
+causes tt(disable) to act on aliases.  The tt(-f) option causes
+tt(disable) to act on shell functions.  The tt(-r) options causes
+tt(disable) to act on reserved words.  Without arguments all disabled
+hash table elements from the corresponding hash table are printed.
+With the tt(-m) flag the arguments are taken as patterns (should be
+quoted to preserve them from being taken as glob patterns), and all hash
+table elements from the corresponding hash table matching these patterns
+are disabled.  Disabled objects can be enabled with the tt(enable)
+command.
+)
+findex(disown)
+cindex(jobs, disowning)
+xitem(tt(disown) [ var(job) ... ])
+xitem(var(job) ... tt(&|))
+item(var(job) ... tt(&!))(
+Remove the specified var(job)s from the job table; the shell will
+no longer report their status, and will not complain if you
+try to exit an interactive shell with them running or stopped.
+If no var(job) is specified, disown the current job.
+)
+findex(echo)
+item(tt(echo) [ tt(-neE) ] [ var(arg) ... ])(
+Write each var(arg) on the standard output, with a space separating
+each one.
+If the tt(-n) flag is not present, print a newline at the end.
+tt(echo) recognizes the following escape sequences:
+
+startsitem()
+sitem(tt(\a))(bell character)
+sitem(tt(\b))(backspace)
+sitem(tt(\c))(suppress final newline)
+sitem(tt(\e))(escape)
+sitem(tt(\f))(form feed)
+sitem(tt(\n))(linefeed (newline))
+sitem(tt(\r))(carriage return)
+sitem(tt(\t))(horizontal tab)
+sitem(tt(\v))(vertical tab)
+sitem(tt(\\))(backslash)
+sitem(tt(\0)var(NNN))(character code in octal)
+sitem(tt(\x)var(NN))(character code in hexadecimal)
+endsitem()
+
+pindex(BSD_ECHO, use of)
+The tt(-E) flag, or the tt(BSD_ECHO) option, can be used to disable
+these escape sequences.  In the latter case, tt(-e) flag can be used to
+enable them.
+)
+findex(echotc)
+cindex(termcap string, printing)
+item(tt(echotc) var(cap) [ var(arg) ... ])(
+Output the termcap string corresponding to the capability
+var(cap), with optional arguments.
+)
+findex(emulate)
+cindex(compatibility, sh)
+cindex(compatibility, ksh)
+cindex(compatibility, csh)
+cindex(sh, compatibility)
+cindex(ksh, compatibility)
+cindex(csh, compatibility)
+item(tt(emulate) [ tt(-R) ] {tt(zsh)|tt(sh)|tt(ksh)|tt(csh)})(
+Set up zsh options to emulate the specified shell as much as possible.
+bf(csh) will never be fully emulated.
+If the argument is not one of the shells listed above, tt(zsh)
+will be used as a default.  If the tt(-R) option is given, all options
+are reset to their default value corresponding to the specified emulation
+mode.
+)
+findex(enable)
+cindex(enabling commands)
+cindex(commands, enabling)
+item(tt(enable) [ tt(-afmr) ] var(name) ...)(
+Enable the var(name)d hash table elements, presumably disabled
+earlier with tt(disable).  The default is to enable builtin commands.
+The tt(-a) option causes tt(enable) to act on aliases.  The tt(-f)
+option causes tt(enable) to act on shell functions.  The tt(-r)
+option causes tt(enable) to act on reserved words.  Without arguments
+all enabled hash table elements from the corresponding hash table are
+printed.  With the tt(-m) flag the arguments are taken as patterns
+(should be quoted) and all hash table elements from the corresponding
+hash table matching these patterns are enabled.  Enabled objects can be
+disabled with the tt(disable) builtin command.
+)
+findex(eval)
+cindex(evaluating arguments as commands)
+item(tt(eval) [ var(arg) ... ])(
+Read the arguments as input to the shell and execute the resulting
+command in the current shell process.
+)
+prefix(exec)
+findex(exit)
+item(tt(exit) [ var(n) ])(
+Exit the shell with the exit code specified by var(n); if none
+is specified, use the exit code from the last command executed.
+pindex(IGNORE_EOF, use of)
+An EOF condition will also cause the shell to exit, unless
+the tt(IGNORE_EOF) option is set.
+)
+findex(export)
+item(tt(export) [ var(name)[tt(=)var(value)] ... ])(
+The specified var(name)s are marked for automatic export
+to the environment of subsequently executed commands.
+Equivalent to tt(typeset -x), except that no parameter will be created
+to hide an existing one in an outer scope.
+If a parameter specified does not
+already exist, it is created in the global scope.
+)
+findex(false)
+cindex(doing nothing, unsuccessfully)
+item(tt(false) [ var(arg) ... ])(
+Do nothing and return an exit code of 1.
+)
+findex(fc)
+cindex(history, editing)
+cindex(editing history)
+xitem(tt(fc) [ tt(-e) var(ename) ] [ tt(-nlrdDfEim) ] [ var(old)tt(=)var(new) ... ] [ var(first) [ var(last) ] ])
+item(tt(fc) tt(-ARWI) [ var(filename) ])(
+Select a range of commands from var(first) to var(last) from the
+history list.
+The arguments var(first) and var(last) may be specified as a
+number or as a string.  A negative number is used as an offset
+to the current history event number.
+A string specifies the most recent event beginning with the given string.
+All substitutions var(old)tt(=)var(new), if any, are then performed
+on the commands.
+
+If the tt(-l) flag is given, the resulting commands are listed on
+standard output.
+If the tt(-m) flag is also given the first argument is taken as a
+pattern (should be quoted) and only the history events matching this
+pattern will be shown.
+Otherwise the editor program var(ename) is invoked on a file containing
+these history events.  If var(ename) is not given, the value
+of the parameter tt(FCEDIT) is used.  If var(ename) is `tt(-)',
+no editor is invoked.  When editing is complete, the edited
+command is executed.
+
+If var(first) is not specified, it will be set to -1 (the most recent
+event), or to -16 if the tt(-l) flag is given.
+If var(last) is not specified, it will be set to var(first),
+or to -1 if the tt(-l) flag is given.
+
+The flag tt(-r) reverses the order of the commands and the
+flag tt(-n) suppresses command numbers when listing.
+Also when listing, tt(-d) prints timestamps for each command, and
+tt(-f) prints full time-date stamps.  Adding the tt(-E) flag
+causes the dates to be printed as `var(dd)tt(.)var(mm)tt(.)var(yyyy)',
+instead of the default `var(mm)tt(/)var(dd)tt(/)var(yyyy)'.
+Adding the tt(-i) flag causes the dates to be printed in ISO8601
+`var(yyyy)tt(-)var(mm)tt(-)var(dd)' format.
+With the tt(-D) flag, tt(fc) prints elapsed times.
+
+cindex(history, file)
+cindex(file, history)
+tt(fc -R) reads the history from the given file,
+tt(fc -W) writes the history out to the given file,
+and tt(fc -A) appends the history out to the given file.
+If the tt(-I) option is added, only those
+events that are new since last incremental append (write) to
+the history file are appended (written).
+In any case the file will have no more than tt($SAVEHIST)
+entries.
+)
+findex(fg)
+cindex(jobs, foregrounding)
+cindex(jobs, resuming)
+xitem(tt(fg) [ var(job) ... ])
+item(var(job) ...)(
+Bring each specified var(job) in turn to the foreground.
+If no var(job) is specified, resume the current job.
+)
+findex(functions)
+item(tt(functions) [ {tt(PLUS())|tt(-)}tt(tum) ] [ var(name) ... ])(
+Equivalent to tt(typeset -f).
+)
+findex(getln)
+cindex(line, reading)
+cindex(reading a line)
+item(tt(getln) [ tt(-AclneE) ] var(name) ...)(
+Read the top value from the buffer stack and put it in
+the shell parameter tt(name).  Equivalent to
+tt(read -zr).
+)
+findex(getopts)
+cindex(options, processing)
+item(tt(getopts) var(optstring) var(name) [ var(arg) ... ])(
+Checks the var(arg)s for legal options.  If the var(arg)s are omitted,
+use the positional parameters.  A valid option argument
+begins with a `tt(PLUS())' or a `tt(-)'.  An argument not beginning with
+a `tt(PLUS())' or a `tt(-)', or the argument `tt(--)', ends the options.
+var(optstring) contains the letters that tt(getopts)
+recognizes.  If a letter is followed by a `tt(:)', that option
+is expected to have an argument.  The options can be
+separated from the argument by blanks.
+
+Each time it is invoked, tt(getopts) places the option letter it finds
+in the shell parameter var(name), prepended with a `tt(PLUS())' when
+var(arg) begins with a `tt(PLUS())'.  The index of the next var(arg)
+is stored in tt(OPTIND).  The option argument, if any,
+is stored in tt(OPTARG).
+vindex(OPTIND, use of)
+vindex(OPTARG, use of)
+
+A leading `tt(:)' in var(optstring) causes tt(getopts) to store the
+letter of the invalid option in tt(OPTARG), and to set var(name)
+to `tt(?)' for an unknown option and to `tt(:)' when a required option
+is missing.  Otherwise, tt(getopts) prints an error
+message.  The exit status is nonzero when there are no more options.
+)
+findex(hash)
+item(tt(hash) [ tt(-dfmrv) ] [ var(name)[tt(=)var(value)] ] ...)(
+tt(hash) can be used to directly modify the contents of the command
+hash table, and the named directory hash table.  Normally one would
+modify these tables by modifying one's tt(PATH)
+(for the command hash table) or by creating appropriate shell parameters
+(for the named directory hash table).
+The choice of hash table to work on is determined by the tt(-d) option;
+without the option the command hash table is used, and with the option the
+named directory hash table is used.
+
+Given no arguments, and neither the tt(-r) or tt(-f) options,
+the selected hash table will be listed in full.
+
+The tt(-r) option causes the selected hash table to be emptied.
+It will be subsequently rebuilt in the normal fashion.
+The tt(-f) option causes the selected hash table to be fully
+rebuilt immediately.  For the command hash table this hashes
+all the absolute directories in the tt(PATH),
+and for the named directory hash table this adds all users' home directories.
+These two options cannot be used with any arguments.
+
+The tt(-m) option causes the arguments to be taken as patterns
+(they should be quoted) and the elements of the hash table
+matching those patterns are printed.  This is the only way to display
+a limited selection of hash table elements.
+
+For each var(name) with a corresponding var(value), put `var(name)' in
+the selected hash table, associating it with the pathname `var(value)'.
+In the command hash table, this means that
+whenever `var(name)' is used as a command argument, the shell will try
+to execute the file given by `var(value)'.
+In the named directory hash table, this means
+that `var(value)' may be referred to as `tt(~)var(name)'.
+
+For each var(name) with no
+corresponding var(value), attempt to add var(name) to the hash table,
+checking what the appropriate tt(value) is in the normal manner for
+that hash table.  If an appropriate tt(value) can't be found, then
+the hash table will be unchanged.
+
+The tt(-v) option causes hash table entries to be listed as they are
+added by explicit specification.  If has no effect if used with tt(-f).
+)
+alias(history)(fc -l)
+findex(integer)
+item(tt(integer) [ {tt(PLUS())|tt(-)}tt(lrtux) ] [ var(name)[tt(=)var(value)] ... ])(
+Equivalent to tt(typeset -i), except that options irrelevant to
+integers are not permitted.
+)
+findex(jobs)
+xitem(tt(jobs) [ tt(-dlprs) ] [ var(job) ... ])
+item(tt(jobs -Z) var(string))(
+Lists information about each given job, or all jobs
+if var(job) is omitted.  The tt(-l) flag lists process
+IDs, and the tt(-p) flag lists process groups.
+If the tt(-r) flag is specified only running jobs will be listed
+and if the tt(-s) flag is given only stopped jobs are shown.
+If the tt(-d) flag is given, the directory from which the job was
+started (which may not be the current directory of the job) will also
+be shown.
+
+The tt(-Z) option replaces the shell's argument and environment space with
+the given string, truncated if necessary to fit.  This will normally be
+visible in tt(ps) (manref(ps)(1)) listings.  This feature is typically
+used by daemons, to indicate their state.
+)
+findex(kill)
+cindex(killing jobs)
+cindex(jobs, killing)
+xitem(tt(kill) [ tt(-s) var(signal_name) ] var(job) ...)
+xitem(tt(kill) [ tt(-)var(sig) ] var(job) ...)
+item(tt(kill) tt(-l) [ var(sig) ... ])(
+Sends either tt(SIGTERM) or the specified signal to the given
+jobs or processes.
+Signals are given by number or by names, without the `tt(SIG)' prefix.
+If the signal being sent is not `tt(KILL)' or `tt(CONT)', then the job
+will be sent a `tt(CONT)' signal if it is stopped.
+The argument var(job) can be the process ID of a job
+not in the job list.
+In the third form, tt(kill -l), if var(sig) is not
+specified the signal names are listed.  Otherwise, for each
+var(sig) that is a name, the corresponding signal number is
+listed.  For each var(sig) that is a signal number or a number
+representing the exit status of a process which was terminated or
+stopped by a signal the name of the signal is printed.
+)
+findex(let)
+item(tt(let) var(arg) ...)(
+Evaluate each var(arg) as an arithmetic expression.
+See noderef(Arithmetic Evaluation) for a description
+of arithmetic expressions.  The exit status is 0 if the
+value of the last expression is nonzero, and 1 otherwise.
+)
+findex(limit)
+cindex(resource limits)
+cindex(limits, resource)
+item(tt(limit) [ tt(-hs) ] [ var(resource) [ var(limit) ] ] ...)(
+Set or display resource limits.  Unless the tt(-s) flag is given,
+the limit applies only the children of the shell.  If tt(-s) is
+given without other arguments, the resource limits of the current
+shell is set to the previously set resource limits of the children.
+
+If var(limit) is not specified, print the current limit placed
+on var(resource), otherwise
+set the limit to the specified value.  If the tt(-h) flag
+is given, use hard limits instead of soft limits.
+If no var(resource) is given, print all limits.
+
+var(resource) can be one of:
+
+startsitem()
+sitem(tt(memorylocked))(Maximum amount of memory locked in RAM.)
+sitem(tt(resident))(Maximum resident set size.)
+sitem(tt(vmemorysize))(Maximum amount of virtual memory.)
+sitem(tt(descriptors))(Maximum value for a file descriptor.)
+sitem(tt(coredumpsize))(Maximum size of a core dump.)
+sitem(tt(stacksize))(Maximum stack size for each process.)
+sitem(tt(datasize))(Maximum data size (including stack) for each process.)
+sitem(tt(filesize))(Largest single file allowed.)
+sitem(tt(cputime))(Maximum CPU seconds per process.)
+sitem(tt(maxproc))(Maximum number of processes.)
+sitem(tt(addressspace))(Maximum amount of address space used.)
+sitem(tt(cachedthreads))(Maximum number of cached threads.)
+endsitem()
+
+Which of these resource limits are available depends on the system.
+var(resource) can be abbreviated to any unambiguous prefix.
+
+var(limit) is a number, with an optional scaling factor, as follows:
+
+startsitem()
+sitem(var(n)tt(h))(hours)
+sitem(var(n)tt(k))(kilobytes (default))
+sitem(var(n)tt(m))(megabytes or minutes)
+sitem([var(mm)tt(:)]var(ss))(minutes and seconds)
+endsitem()
+)
+findex(local)
+item(tt(local) [ {tt(PLUS())|tt(-)}tt(LRZilrtu) [var(n)]] [ var(name)[tt(=)var(value)] ] ...)(
+Same as tt(typeset), except that the options tt(-x) and
+tt(-f) are not permitted.
+)
+findex(log)
+vindex(watch, use of)
+cindex(watching users)
+cindex(users, watching)
+item(tt(log))(
+List all users currently logged in who are affected by
+the current setting of the tt(watch) parameter.
+)
+findex(logout)
+item(tt(logout) [ var(n) ])(
+Same as tt(exit), except that it only works in a login shell.
+)
+prefix(noglob)
+findex(popd)
+item(tt(popd) [ {tt(PLUS())|tt(-)}var(n) ])(
+Removes a entry from the directory stack, and perform a tt(cd) to
+the new top directory. With no argument, the current top entry is
+removed.  An argument of the form `tt(PLUS())var(n)' identifies a stack
+entry by counting from the left of the list shown by the tt(dirs) command,
+starting with zero.  An argument of the form tt(-n) counts from the right.
+pindex(PUSHD_MINUS, use of)
+If the tt(PUSHD_MINUS) option is set, the meanings of `tt(PLUS())' and
+`tt(-)' in this context are swapped.
+)
+findex(print)
+item(tt(print) [ tt(-nrslzpNDPoOicm) ] [ tt(-u)var(n) ] [ tt(-R) [ tt(-en) ]] [ var(arg) ... ])(
+With no flags or with flag `tt(-)', the arguments are printed on
+the standard output as described by tt(echo), with the following differences:
+the escape sequence `tt(\M-)var(x)' metafies the character
+var(x) (sets the highest bit),
+`tt(\C-)var(x)' produces a control character (`tt(\C-@)' and `tt(\C-?)' give the
+characters NUL and delete), and `tt(\E)' is a synonym for `tt(\e)'.
+Finally, if not in an escape
+sequence, `tt(\)' escapes the following character and is not printed.
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(-r))(
+Ignore the escape conventions of tt(echo).
+)
+item(tt(-R))(
+Emulate the BSD tt(echo) command, which does not process escape sequences
+unless the tt(-e) flag is given.  The tt(-n) flag suppresses the trailing
+newline.  Only the tt(-e) and tt(-n) flags are recognized after
+tt(-R); all other arguments and options are printed.
+)
+item(tt(-m))(
+Take the first argument as a pattern (should be quoted), and remove
+it from the argument list together with subsequent arguments that
+do not match this pattern.
+)
+item(tt(-s))(
+Place the results in the history list instead of on the standard output.
+)
+item(tt(-n))(
+Do not add a newline to the output.
+)
+item(tt(-l))(
+Print the arguments separated by newlines instead of spaces.
+)
+item(tt(-N))(
+Print the arguments separated and terminated by nulls.
+)
+item(tt(-o))(
+Print the arguments sorted in ascending order.
+)
+item(tt(-O))(
+Print the arguments sorted in descending order.
+)
+item(tt(-i))(
+If given together with tt(-o) or tt(-O), makes them work case
+independently.
+)
+item(tt(-c))(
+Print the arguments in columns.
+)
+item(tt(-u)var(n))(
+Print the arguments to file descriptor var(n).
+)
+item(tt(-p))(
+Print the arguments to the input of the coprocess.
+)
+item(tt(-z))(
+Push the arguments onto the editing buffer stack, separated by spaces;
+no escape sequences are recognized.
+)
+item(tt(-D))(
+Treat the arguments as directory names, replacing prefixes with tt(~)
+expressions, as appropriate.
+)
+item(tt(-P))(
+Perform prompt expansion (see noderef(Prompt Expansion)).
+)
+enditem()
+)
+findex(pushd)
+pindex(PUSHD_TO_HOME, use of)
+pindex(PUSHD_MINUS, use of)
+pindex(CDABLE_VARS, use of)
+pindex(PUSHD_SILENT, use of)
+xitem(tt(pushd) [ var(arg) ])
+xitem(tt(pushd) var(old) var(new))
+item(tt(pushd) {tt(PLUS())|tt(-)}var(n))(
+Change the current directory, and push the old current directory
+onto the directory stack.  In the first form, change the
+current directory to var(arg).
+If var(arg) is not specified, change to the second directory
+on the stack (that is, exchange the top two entries), or
+change to tt($HOME) if the tt(PUSHD_TO_HOME)
+option is set or if there is only one entry on the stack.
+
+If var(arg) is `tt(-)', change to tt($OLDPWD), the previous directory.
+If a directory named var(arg) is not found in the current directory
+and var(arg) does not contain a slash,
+search each component of the shell parameter tt(cdpath).
+If the option tt(CDABLE_VARS) is set, and a parameter named var(arg)
+exists whose value begins with a slash, treat its value as
+the directory.
+
+If the option tt(PUSHD_SILENT) is not set, the directory
+stack will be printed after a tt(pushd) is performed.
+
+The second form of tt(pushd) substitutes the string var(new)
+for the string var(old) in the name of the current directory,
+and tries to change to this new directory.
+
+The third form of tt(pushd) changes directory by rotating the
+directory list.  An argument of the form `tt(PLUS())var(n)' identifies a stack
+entry by counting from the left of the list shown by the tt(dirs)
+command, starting with zero.  An argument of the form `tt(-)var(n)' counts
+from the right.  If the tt(PUSHD_MINUS) option is set, the meanings
+of `tt(PLUS())' and `tt(-)' in this context are swapped.
+)
+findex(pushln)
+item(tt(pushln) [ var(arg) ... ])(
+Equivalent to tt(print -nz).
+)
+findex(pwd)
+pindex(CHASE_LINKS, use of)
+item(tt(pwd) [ tt(-rLP) ])(
+Print the absolute pathname of the current working directory.
+If the tt(-r) or the tt(-P) flag is specified, or the tt(CHASE_LINKS)
+option is set and the tt(-L) flag is not given, the printed path will not
+contain symbolic links.
+)
+alias(r)(fc -e -)
+findex(read)
+vindex(IFS, use of)
+item(tt(read) [ tt(-rzpqAclneE) ] [ tt(-k) [ var(num) ] ] \
+[ tt(-u)var(n) ] [ var(name)[tt(?)var(prompt)] ] [ var(name) ...  ])(
+Read one line and break it into fields using the characters
+in tt($IFS) as separators, except as noted below.
+The first field is assigned to the first var(name), the second field
+to the second var(name), etc., with leftover
+fields assigned to the last var(name).
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(-r))(
+Raw mode: a `tt(\)' at the end of a line does not signify line
+continuation.
+)
+item(tt(-q))(
+Read only one character from the terminal and set var(name) to
+`tt(y)' if this character was `tt(y)' or `tt(Y)' and to `tt(n)' otherwise.
+With this flag set the return value is zero only if the character was
+`tt(y)' or `tt(Y)'.  Note that this always reads from the terminal, even
+if used with the tt(-p) or tt(-u) or tt(-z) flags or with redirected input.
+)
+item(tt(-k) [ var(num) ])(
+Read only one (or var(num)) characters.  All are assigned to the first
+var(name), without word splitting.  This flag is ignored when tt(-q) is
+present.  Input is read from the terminal unless one of tt(-u) or tt(-p)
+is present.
+)
+item(tt(-z))(
+Read one entry from the editor buffer stack and assign it to the first
+var(name), without word splitting.  Text is pushed onto the stack with
+`tt(print -z)' or with tt(push-line) from the line editor (see
+ifzman(zmanref(zshzle))\
+ifnzman(noderef(Zsh Line Editor))\
+).  This flag is ignored when the tt(-k) or tt(-q) flags are present.
+)
+xitem(tt(-e))
+item(tt(-E))(
+The input read is printed (echoed) to the standard output.  If the tt(-e)
+flag is used, no input is assigned to the parameters.
+)
+item(tt(-A))(
+The first var(name) is taken as the name of an array and all words are
+assigned to it.
+)
+xitem(tt(-c))
+item(tt(-l))(
+These flags are allowed only if called inside a
+function used for completion (specified with the tt(-K) flag to
+tt(compctl)).  If the tt(-c) flag is given, the words of the
+current command are read. If the tt(-l) flag is given, the whole
+line is assigned as a scalar.  If both flags are present, tt(-l)
+is used and tt(-c) is ignored.  If var(name) is omitted then
+tt(REPLY) is used for scalars and tt(reply) for arrays.
+)
+item(tt(-n))(
+Together with tt(-c), the number of the word the cursor is on is
+read.  With tt(-l), the index of the character the cursor is on is
+read.  Note that the command name is word number 1, not word 0,
+and that when the cursor is at the end of the line, its character
+index is the length of the line plus one.
+)
+item(tt(-u)var(n))(
+Input is read from file descriptor var(n).
+)
+item(tt(-p))(
+Input is read from the coprocess.
+)
+enditem()
+
+If the first argument contains a `tt(?)', the remainder of this
+word is used as a var(prompt) on standard error when the shell
+is interactive.
+
+The value (exit status) of tt(read) is 1 when an end-of-file is
+encountered, or when tt(-c) or tt(-l) is present and the command is
+not called from a tt(compctl) function.  Otherwise the value is 0.
+
+The behavior of some combinations of the tt(-k), tt(-p), tt(-q), tt(-u)
+and tt(-z) flags is undefined.  Presently tt(-q) cancels all the others,
+tt(-p) cancels tt(-u), tt(-k) cancels tt(-z), and otherwise tt(-z)
+cancels both tt(-p) and tt(-u).
+
+The tt(-c) or tt(-l) flags cancel any and all of tt(-kpquz).
+)
+cindex(parameters, marking readonly)
+alias(readonly)(typeset -r)
+alias(rehash)(hash -r)
+findex(return)
+cindex(functions, returning from)
+item(tt(return) [ var(n) ])(
+Causes a shell function or tt(.) script to return to
+the invoking script with the return status specified by var(n).  If var(n)
+is omitted, the return status is that of the last command
+executed.
+
+If tt(return) was executed from a trap in a tt(TRAP)var(NAL) function,
+the effect is different for zero and non-zero return status.  With zero
+status (or after an implicit return at the end of the trap), the shell
+will return to whatever it was previously processing; with a non-zero
+status, the shell will behave as interrupted except that the return
+status of the trap is retained.  Note that the signal which caused the
+trap is passed as the first argument, so the statement `tt(return
+$((128PLUS()$1)))' will return the same status as if the signal had not
+been trapped.
+)
+findex(set)
+cindex(parameters, listing)
+cindex(parameters, positional)
+cindex(parameters, setting array)
+cindex(array parameters, setting)
+item(tt(set) [ {tt(PLUS())|tt(-)}var(options) | {tt(PLUS())|tt(-)}tt(o) var(option_name) ] ... [ {tt(PLUS())|tt(-)}tt(A) [ var(name) ] ] [ var(arg) ... ])(
+Set the options for the shell and/or set the positional parameters, or
+declare and set an array.  If the tt(-s) option is given, it causes the
+specified arguments to be sorted before assigning them to the positional
+parameters (or to the array var(name) if tt(-A) is used).  With tt(PLUS()s)
+sort arguments in descending order.  For the meaning of the other flags, see
+ifzman(zmanref(zshoptions))\
+ifnzman(noderef(Options))\
+.  Flags may be specified by name using the tt(-o) option.
+
+If the tt(-A) flag is specified, var(name) is
+set to an array containing the given var(arg)s. if tt(PLUS()A) is used and
+var(name) is an array, the given arguments will replace the initial
+elements of that array; if no var(name) is specified, all arrays are
+printed.  Otherwise the positional parameters are set.  If no arguments are
+given, then the names and values of all parameters are printed on the
+standard output.  If the only argument is `tt(PLUS())',
+the names of all parameters are printed.
+)
+findex(setopt)
+cindex(options, setting)
+item(tt(setopt) [ {tt(PLUS())|tt(-)}var(options) | \
+{tt(PLUS())|tt(-)}tt(o) var(option_name) ] [ var(name) ... ])(
+Set the options for the shell.  All options specified either
+with flags or by name are set.  If no arguments are supplied,
+the names of all options currently set are printed.
+If the tt(-m) flag is given the arguments are taken as patterns
+(which should be quoted to preserve them from being interpreted as glob
+patterns), and all options with names matching these patterns are set.
+)
+findex(shift)
+cindex(parameters, positional)
+item(tt(shift) [ var(n) ] [ var(name) ... ])(
+The positional parameters tt(${)var(n)PLUS()1tt(}) ... are renamed
+to tt($1) ..., where var(n) is an arithmetic expression that
+defaults to 1.
+If any var(name)s are given then the arrays with these names are
+shifted instead of the positional parameters.
+)
+findex(source)
+item(tt(source) var(file) [ var(arg) ... ])(
+Same as tt(.), except that the current directory is always searched and
+is always searched first, before directories in tt($path).
+)
+findex(suspend)
+cindex(shell, suspending)
+cindex(suspending the shell)
+item(tt(suspend) [ tt(-f) ])(
+Suspend the execution of the shell (send it a tt(SIGTSTP))
+until it receives a tt(SIGCONT).
+Unless the tt(-f) option is given, this will refuse to suspend a login shell.
+)
+findex(test)
+xitem(tt(test) [ var(arg) ... ])
+item(tt([) [ var(arg) ... ] tt(]))(
+Like the system version of tt(test).  Added for compatibility;
+use conditional expressions instead (see noderef(Conditional Expressions)).
+)
+findex(times)
+cindex(shell, timing)
+cindex(timing the shell)
+item(tt(times))(
+Print the accumulated user and system times for the shell
+and for processes run from the shell.
+)
+findex(trap)
+cindex(signals, trapping)
+cindex(trapping signals)
+item(tt(trap) [ var(arg) [ var(sig) ... ] ])(
+var(arg) is a command to be read and executed when the shell
+receives var(sig).  Each var(sig) can be given as a number
+or as the name of a signal.
+If var(arg) is `tt(-)', then all traps var(sig) are reset to their
+default values.  If var(arg) is the null string, then this signal
+is ignored by the shell and by the commands it invokes.
+
+If var(sig) is tt(ZERR) then var(arg) will be executed
+after each command with a nonzero exit status.
+If var(sig) is tt(DEBUG) then var(arg) will be executed
+after each command.
+If var(sig) is tt(0) or tt(EXIT)
+and the tt(trap) statement is executed inside the body of a function,
+then the command var(arg) is executed after the function completes.
+If var(sig) is tt(0) or tt(EXIT)
+and the tt(trap) statement is not executed inside the body of a function,
+then the command var(arg) is executed when the shell terminates.
+
+The tt(trap) command with no arguments prints a list of commands
+associated with each signal.
+)
+findex(true)
+cindex(doing nothing, successfully)
+item(tt(true) [ var(arg) ... ])(
+Do nothing and return an exit code of 0.
+)
+findex(ttyctl)
+cindex(tty, freezing)
+item(tt(ttyctl) tt(-fu))(
+The tt(-f) option freezes the tty, and tt(-u) unfreezes it.
+When the tty is frozen, no changes made to the tty settings by
+external programs will be honored by the shell, except for changes in the
+size of the screen; the shell will
+simply reset the settings to their previous values as soon as each
+command exits or is suspended.  Thus, tt(stty) and similar programs have
+no effect when the tty is frozen.  Without options it reports whether the
+terminal is frozen or not.
+)
+findex(type)
+item(tt(type) [ tt(-wfpams) ] var(name) ...)(
+Equivalent to tt(whence -v).
+)
+findex(typeset)
+cindex(parameters, setting)
+cindex(parameters, declaring)
+item(tt(typeset) [ {tt(PLUS())|tt(-)}tt(LRUZfilrtuxm) [var(n)]] [ var(name)[tt(=)var(value)] ... ])(
+Set attributes and values for shell parameters.
+When invoked inside a function a new parameter is created which will be
+unset when the function completes.  The new parameter will not be
+exported unless tt(ALL_EXPORT) is set, in which case the parameter will be
+exported provided no parameter of that name already exists.
+The following attributes are valid:
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(-L))(
+Left justify and remove leading blanks from var(value).
+If var(n) is nonzero, it defines the width of the field;
+otherwise it is determined by the width of the value of the first
+assignment.
+When the parameter is printed, it is filled on the right with
+blanks or truncated if necessary to fit the field.
+Leading zeros are removed if the tt(-Z) flag is also set.
+)
+item(tt(-R))(
+Right justify and fill with leading blanks.  If var(n) is nonzero
+if defines the width of the field;
+otherwise it is determined by the width of the value of the first
+assignment.
+When the parameter is printed, the field is left filled with
+blanks or truncated from the end.
+)
+item(tt(-U))(
+For arrays keep only the first element of each duplications. It can also be
+set for colon separated special parameters like tt(PATH) or tt(FIGNORE),
+etc.
+)
+item(tt(-Z))(
+Right justify and fill with leading zeros if the first non-blank
+character is a digit and the tt(-L) flag has not been set.
+If var(n) is nonzero it defines the width of the field;
+otherwise it is determined by the width of the value of the
+first assignment.
+)
+item(tt(-f))(
+The names refer to functions rather than parameters.  No assignments
+can be made, and the only other valid flags are tt(-t)
+and tt(-u).  The flag tt(-t) turns on execution tracing for this
+function.  The flag tt(-u) causes this function to be marked
+for autoloading.  The tt(fpath) parameter will be searched to find the
+function definition when the function is first referenced; see
+noderef(Functions).
+)
+item(tt(-i))(
+Use an internal integer representation.  If var(n) is nonzero
+it defines the output arithmetic base, otherwise it is determined by the first
+assignment.
+)
+item(tt(-l))(
+Convert to lower case.
+)
+item(tt(-r))(
+The given var(name)s are marked readonly.
+)
+item(tt(-t))(
+Tags the named parameters.  Tags have no special meaning to the shell.
+)
+item(tt(-u))(
+Convert to upper case.
+)
+item(tt(-x))(
+Mark for automatic export to the environment of subsequently
+executed commands.
+)
+enditem()
+
+Using `tt(PLUS())' rather than `tt(-)' causes these flags to be turned off.
+If no arguments are given but flags are specified,
+a list of named parameters which have these flags set is printed.
+Using `tt(PLUS())' instead of `tt(-)' keeps their values from being printed.
+If no arguments or options are given, the names and attributes
+of all parameters are printed. If only the tt(-m) flag is given the
+arguments are taken as patterns (should be quoted) and all parameters
+or functions (with the tt(-f) flag) with matching names are printed.
+)
+findex(ulimit)
+cindex(resource limits)
+cindex(limits, resource)
+item(tt(ulimit) [ tt(-SHacdflmnpstv) [ tt(limit) ] ... ])(
+Set or display resource limits of the shell and the processes started by
+the shell.  The value of var(limit) can be a number in the unit specified
+below or the value `tt(unlimited)'.  If the tt(-H) flag is given use
+hard limits instead of soft limits.  If the tt(-S) flag is given
+together with the tt(-H) flag set both hard and soft limits.  If no
+options are used, the file size limit (tt(-f)) is assumed.  If
+var(limit) is omitted the current value of the specified resources are
+printed.  When more than one resource values are printed the limit name and
+unit is printed before each value.
+
+startsitem()
+sitem(tt(-a))(Lists all of the current resource limits.)
+sitem(tt(-c))(512-byte blocks on the size of core dumps.)
+sitem(tt(-d))(K-bytes on the size of the data segment.)
+sitem(tt(-f))(512-byte blocks on the size of files written.)
+sitem(tt(-l))(K-bytes on the size of locked-in memory.)
+sitem(tt(-m))(K-bytes on the size of physical memory.)
+sitem(tt(-n))(open file descriptors.)
+sitem(tt(-s))(K-bytes on the size of the stack.)
+sitem(tt(-t))(CPU seconds to be used.)
+sitem(tt(-u))(processes available to the user.)
+sitem(tt(-v))(K-bytes on the size of virtual memory.)
+endsitem()
+)
+findex(umask)
+cindex(umask)
+item(tt(umask) [ tt(-S) ] [ var(mask) ])(
+The umask is set to var(mask).  var(mask) can be either
+an octal number or a symbolic value as described in manref(chmod)(1).
+If var(mask) is omitted, the current value is printed.  The tt(-S)
+option causes the mask to be printed as a symbolic value.  Otherwise,
+the mask is printed as an octal number.  Note that in
+the symbolic form the permissions you specify are those which are to be
+allowed (not denied) to the users specified.
+)
+cindex(aliases, removing)
+alias(unalias)(unhash -a)
+cindex(functions, removing)
+alias(unfunction)(unhash -f)
+findex(unhash)
+item(tt(unhash) [ tt(-adfm) ] var(name) ...)(
+Remove the element named var(name) from an internal hash table.  The
+default is remove elements from the command hash table.  The tt(-a)
+option causes tt(unhash) to remove aliases.  The tt(-f) option causes
+tt(unhash) to remove shell functions.  The tt(-d) options causes
+tt(unhash) to remove named directories.  If the tt(-m) flag is given
+the arguments are taken as patterns (should be quoted) and all elements
+of the corresponding hash table with matching names will be removed.
+)
+findex(unlimit)
+cindex(resource limits)
+cindex(limits, resource)
+item(tt(unlimit) [ tt(-hs) ] var(resource) ...)(
+The resource limit for each var(resource) is set to the hard limit.
+If the tt(-h) flag is given and the shell has appropriate privileges,
+the hard resource limit for each var(resource) is removed.
+The resources of the shell process are only changed if the tt(-s)
+flag is given.
+)
+findex(unset)
+cindex(parameters, unsetting)
+item(tt(unset) [ tt(-fm) ] var(name) ...)(
+Each named parameter is unset.
+Local parameters remain local even if unset; they appear unset within scope,
+but the previous value will still reappear when the scope ends.
+
+If the tt(-m) flag is specified the
+arguments are taken as patterns (should be quoted) and all parameters
+with matching names are unset.  tt(unset -f) is equivalent to
+tt(unfunction).
+)
+findex(unsetopt)
+cindex(options, unsetting)
+item(tt(unsetopt) [ {tt(PLUS())|tt(-)}var(options) | \
+{tt(PLUS())|tt(-)}tt(o) var(option_name) ] [ var(name) ... ])(
+Unset the options for the shell.  All options specified either
+with flags or by name are unset.  If no arguments are supplied,
+the names of all options currently unset are printed.
+If the tt(-m) flag is given the arguments are taken as patterns
+(which should be quoted to preserve them from being interpreted as glob
+patterns), and all options with names matching these patterns are unset.
+)
+findex(wait)
+cindex(waiting for jobs)
+cindex(jobs, waiting for)
+item(tt(wait) [ var(job) ... ])(
+Wait for the specified jobs or processes.  If var(job) is not given
+then all currently active child processes are waited for.
+Each var(job) can be either a job specification or the process ID
+of a job in the job table.
+The exit status from this command is that of the job waited for.
+)
+findex(whence)
+item(tt(whence) [ tt(-vcwfpams) ] var(name) ...)(
+For each name, indicate how it would be interpreted if used as a
+command name.
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(-v))(
+Produce a more verbose report.
+)
+item(tt(-c))(
+Print the results in a bf(csh)-like format.
+This takes precedence over tt(-v).
+)
+item(tt(-w))(
+For each var(name), print `var(name)tt(:) var(word)' where var(word)
+is one of tt(alias), tt(builtin), tt(command), tt(function),
+tt(hashed), tt(reserved) or tt(none), according as var(name)
+corresponds to an alias, a built-in command, an external command, a
+shell function, a command defined with the tt(hash) builtin, a
+reserved word, or is not recognised.  This takes precedence over
+tt(-v) and tt(-c).
+)
+item(tt(-f))(
+Causes the contents of a shell function to be
+displayed, which would otherwise not happen unless the tt(-c)
+flag were used.
+)
+item(tt(-p))(
+Do a path search for var(name)
+even if it is an alias, reserved word, shell function or builtin.
+)
+item(tt(-a))(
+Do a search for all occurrences of var(name)
+throughout the command path.
+Normally only the first occurrence is printed.
+)
+item(tt(-m))(
+The arguments are taken as patterns (should be
+quoted), and the information is displayed for each command matching one
+of these patterns.
+)
+item(tt(-s))(
+If a pathname contains symlinks, print the symlink-free pathname as well.
+)
+enditem()
+)
+findex(where)
+item(tt(where) [ tt(-wpms) ] var(name) ...)(
+Equivalent to tt(whence -ca).
+)
+findex(which)
+item(tt(which) [ tt(-wpams) ] var(name) ...)(
+Equivalent to tt(whence -c).
+)
+findex(zmodload)
+cindex(modules, loading)
+cindex(loading modules)
+xitem(tt(zmodload) [ tt(-iL) ] [ var(name) ... ])
+xitem(tt(zmodload) tt(-u) [ tt(-i) ] var(name) ...)
+xitem(tt(zmodload) tt(-d) [ tt(-L) ] [ var(name) [ var(dep) ... ] ])
+xitem(tt(zmodload) tt(-du) var(name) [ var(dep) ... ])
+xitem(tt(zmodload) tt(-a) [ tt(-iL) ] [ var(name) [ var(builtin) ... ] ])
+item(tt(zmodload) tt(-au) [ tt(-i) ] var(builtin) ...)(
+tt(zmodload) performs operations relating to zsh's loadable modules.
+This feature is not available on all operating systems,
+or on all installations on a particular operating system.
+
+In the simplest case,
+tt(zmodload) loads a binary module.  The module must be in a file with a
+name consisting of the specified var(name) followed by a standard suffix,
+usually `tt(.so)'.  If this can't be found, the var(name) is tried without
+the suffix.
+If the module to be loaded is already loaded and the tt(-i)
+option is given, the duplicate module is ignored.  Otherwise
+tt(zmodload) prints an error message.
+
+The var(name)d module is searched for in the same way a command is, using
+tt($module_path) instead of tt($path).  If var(name) contains a `tt(/)',
+it will be used as-is, and a path search will be performed otherwise.
+This behaviour can be modified by the tt(PATH_DIRS) option.
+cindex(PATH_DIRS, use of)
+
+With tt(-u), tt(zmodload) unloads modules.  The same var(name)
+must be given that was given when the module was loaded, but it is not
+necessary for the module to exist in the filesystem.
+The tt(-i) option suppresses the error if the module is already
+unloaded (or was never loaded).
+
+Each module has a boot and a cleanup function.  The module
+will not be loaded if its boot function fails.  Similarly a module
+can only be unloaded if its cleanup function runs successfully.
+
+Without arguments all currently loaded binary modules are printed.
+The tt(-L) option causes this list to be in the form of a series of
+tt(zmodload) commands.
+
+The tt(-d) option can be used to specify module dependencies.
+This operation is idempotent regardless of the tt(-i) option.
+The modules named in the second and subsequent arguments will be
+loaded before the module named in the first argument.
+
+With tt(-d) and one
+argument, all dependencies for that module are listed.  With tt(-d) and no
+arguments, all module dependencies are listed.
+This listing is by default in a Makefile-like format.
+The tt(-L) option changes this format to a list of
+tt(zmodload -d) commands.
+
+If tt(-d) and tt(-u) are both used, dependencies are removed.
+This operation is idempotent regardless of the tt(-i) option.
+If only one argument is given, all dependencies for that module are removed.
+
+The tt(-a) option defines autoloaded builtins.  It defines the
+specified var(builtin)s.  When any of those builtins is called, the module
+specified in the first argument is loaded.  If only one argument is given,
+one builtin is defined, with the same name as the module.
+tt(-i) suppresses the error if the builtin is already defined or
+autoloaded, regardless of which module it came from.
+
+With tt(-a) and no arguments, all
+autoloaded builtins are listed, with the module name (if different)
+shown in parentheses after the builtin name.  The tt(-L) option changes
+this format to a list of tt(zmodload -a) commands.
+
+If tt(-a) is used
+together with the tt(-u) option it removes builtins defined with
+tt(zmodload -a).  This is only possible if the builtin is not yet
+loaded.  tt(-i) suppresses the error if the builtin is already
+removed (or never existed).
+)
+enditem()
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/compat.yo b/Doc/Zsh/compat.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..529bd4557
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/compat.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,69 @@
+texinode(Compatibility)(Prompt Expansion)(Conditional Expressions)(Top)
+chapter(Compatibility)
+ifzman(\
+sect(Compatibility)
+)\
+cindex(compatibility)
+cindex(sh, compatibility)
+cindex(ksh, compatibility)
+Zsh tries to emulate bf(sh) or bf(ksh) when it is invoked as
+tt(sh) or tt(ksh) respectively.  In this mode the following
+parameters are not special and not initialized by the shell:
+tt(ARGC),
+tt(argv),
+tt(cdpath),
+tt(fignore),
+tt(fpath),
+tt(HISTCHARS),
+tt(mailpath),
+tt(MANPATH),
+tt(manpath),
+tt(path),
+tt(prompt),
+tt(PROMPT),
+tt(PROMPT2),
+tt(PROMPT3),
+tt(PROMPT4),
+tt(psvar),
+tt(status),
+tt(watch).
+
+The usual zsh startup/shutdown scripts are not executed.  Login shells
+source tt(/etc/profile) followed by tt($HOME/.profile).  If the
+tt(ENV) environment variable is set on invocation, tt($ENV) is sourced
+after the profile scripts.  The value of tt(ENV) is subjected to
+parameter expansion, command substitution, and arithmetic expansion before
+being interpreted as a pathname.  Note that the tt(PRIVILEGED) option
+also affects the execution of startup files.
+
+The following options are set if the shell is invoked as tt(sh) or
+tt(ksh):
+tt(NO_BAD_PATTERN),
+tt(NO_BANG_HIST),
+tt(NO_BG_NICE),
+tt(NO_EQUALS),
+tt(NO_FUNCTION_ARGZERO),
+tt(GLOB_SUBST),
+tt(NO_HUP),
+tt(INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS),
+tt(KSH_ARRAYS),
+tt(NO_MULTIOS),
+tt(NO_NOMATCH),
+tt(NO_NOTIFY),
+tt(POSIX_BUILTINS),
+tt(NO_PROMPT_PERCENT),
+tt(RM_STAR_SILENT),
+tt(SH_FILE_EXPANSION),
+tt(SH_GLOB),
+tt(SH_OPTION_LETTERS),
+tt(SH_WORD_SPLIT).
+Additionally the tt(BSD_ECHO) and tt(IGNORE_BRACES)
+options are set if zsh is invoked as tt(sh).
+Also, the
+tt(KSH_OPTION_PRINT),
+tt(LOCAL_OPTIONS),
+tt(PROMPT_BANG),
+tt(PROMPT_SUBST)
+and
+tt(SINGLE_LINE_ZLE)
+options are set if zsh is invoked as tt(ksh).
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/compctl.yo b/Doc/Zsh/compctl.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..a78a18fa9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/compctl.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,526 @@
+texinode(Programmable Completion)(Zsh Modules)(Zsh Line Editor)(Top)
+chapter(Programmable Completion)
+cindex(completion, programmable)
+cindex(completion, controlling)
+findex(compctl)
+sect(Description)
+startlist()
+list(tt(compctl) [ tt(-CDT) ] var(options) [ var(command) ... ])
+list(tt(compctl) [ tt(-CDT) ] var(options) \
+  [ tt(-x) var(pattern) var(options) tt(-) ... tt(--) ] \
+  [ tt(PLUS()) var(options) [ tt(-x) ... tt(--) ] ... [tt(PLUS())] ] \
+  [ var(command) ... ])
+list(tt(compctl) tt(-L) [ tt(-CDT) ] [ var(command) ... ])
+list(tt(compctl) tt(PLUS()) var(command) ...)
+endlist()
+
+Control the editor's completion behavior according to the supplied set
+of var(options).  Various editing commands, notably
+tt(expand-or-complete-word), usually bound to tab, will
+attempt to complete a word typed by the user, while others, notably
+tt(delete-char-or-list), usually bound to ^D in EMACS editing
+mode, list the possibilities; tt(compctl) controls what those
+possibilities are.  They may for example be filenames (the most common
+case, and hence the default), shell variables, or words from a
+user-specified list.
+startmenu()
+menu(Command Flags)
+menu(Option Flags)
+menu(Alternative Completion)
+menu(Extended Completion)
+menu(Example)
+endmenu()
+texinode(Command Flags)(Option Flags)()(Programmable Completion)
+sect(Command Flags)
+Completion of the arguments of a command may be different for each
+command or may use the default.  The behavior when completing the
+command word itself may also be separately specified.  These
+correspond to the following flags and arguments, all of which (except
+for tt(-L)) may be combined with any combination of the
+var(options) described subsequently in noderef(Option Flags):
+
+startitem()
+item(var(command) ...)(
+controls completion for the named commands, which must be listed last
+on the command line.  If completion is attempted for a command with a
+pathname containing slashes and no completion definition is found, the
+search is retried with the last pathname component.  Note that aliases
+are expanded before the command name is determined unless the
+tt(COMPLETE_ALIASES) option is set.  Commands should not be combined
+with the tt(-C), tt(-D) or tt(-T) flags.
+)
+item(tt(-C))(
+controls completion when the command word itself is being completed.
+If no tt(compctl -C) command has been issued,  the names of any
+executable command (whether in the path or specific to the shell, such
+as aliases or functions) are completed.
+)
+item(tt(-D))(
+controls default completion behavior for the arguments of commands not
+assigned any special behavior.  If no tt(compctl -D) command has
+been issued, filenames are completed.
+)
+item(tt(-T))(
+supplies completion flags to be used before any other processing is
+done, even those given to specific commands with other compctl
+definitions.  This is only useful when combined with extended
+completion (the tt(-x) flag, see noderef(Extended Completion) below).
+Using this flag you can define default behavior
+which will apply to all commands without exception, or you can alter
+the standard behavior for all commands.  For example, if your access
+to the user database is too slow and/or it contains too many users (so
+that completion after `tt(~)' is too slow to be usable), you can use
+
+nofill(tt(compctl -Tx  'C[0,*/*]' -f - 's[~]' -k friends -S/))
+
+to complete the strings in the array tt(friends) after a `tt(~)'.
+The first argument is necessary so that this form of ~-completion is
+not tried after the directory name is finished.
+)
+item(tt(-L))(
+lists the existing completion behavior in a manner suitable for
+putting into a start-up script; the existing behavior is not changed.
+Any combination of the above forms may be specified, otherwise all
+defined completions are listed.  Any other flags supplied
+are ignored.
+)
+item(em(no argument))(
+If no argument is given, tt(compctl) lists all defined completions
+in an abbreviated form;  with a list of var(options), all completions
+with those flags set (not counting extended completion) are listed.
+)
+endlist()
+
+If the tt(PLUS()) flag is alone and followed immediately by the var(command)
+list, the completion behavior for all the commands in the list is reset to
+the default.  In other words, completion will subsequently use the
+options specified by the tt(-D) flag.
+texinode(Option Flags)(Alternative Completion)(Command Flags)(Programmable Completion)
+sect(Option Flags)
+startlist()
+list([ tt(-fcFBdeaRGovNAIOPZEnbjrzu/) ])
+list([ tt(-k) var(array) ] [ tt(-g) var(globstring) ] \
+  [ tt(-s) var(subststring) ])
+list([ tt(-K) var(function) ] [ tt(-H) var(num pattern) ])
+list([ tt(-Q) ] [ tt(-P) var(prefix) ] [ tt(-S) var(suffix) ])
+list([ tt(-W) var(file-prefix) ])
+list([ tt(-q) ] [ tt(-X) var(explanation) ] [ tt(-Y) var(explanation) ])
+list([ tt(-y) var(func-or-var) ] [ tt(-l) var(cmd) ] [ tt(-U) ])
+endlist()
+
+The remaining var(options) specify the type of command arguments
+to look for during completion.  Any combination of these flags may be
+specified; the result is a sorted list of all the possibilities.  The
+options are as follows.
+startmenu()
+menu(Simple Flags)
+menu(Flags with Arguments)
+menu(Control Flags)
+endmenu()
+texinode(Simple Flags)(Flags with Arguments)()(Option Flags)
+subsect(Simple Flags)
+These produce completion lists made up by the shell itself:
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(-f))(
+Filenames and filesystem paths.
+)
+item(tt(-/))(
+Just filesystem paths.
+)
+item(tt(-c))(
+Command names, including aliases, shell functions, builtins
+and reserved words.
+)
+item(tt(-F))(
+Function names.
+)
+item(tt(-B))(
+Names of builtin commands.
+)
+item(tt(-m))(
+Names of external commands.
+)
+item(tt(-w))(
+Reserved words.
+)
+item(tt(-a))(
+Alias names.
+)
+item(tt(-R))(
+Names of regular (non-global) aliases.
+)
+item(tt(-G))(
+Names of global aliases.
+)
+item(tt(-d))(
+This can be combined with tt(-F), tt(-B), tt(-w),
+tt(-a), tt(-R) and tt(-G) to get names of disabled
+functions, builtins, reserved words or aliases.
+)
+item(tt(-e))(
+This option (to show enabled commands) is in effect by default, but
+may be combined with tt(-d); tt(-de) in combination with
+tt(-F), tt(-B), tt(-w), tt(-a), tt(-R) and tt(-G)
+will complete names of functions, builtins, reserved words or aliases
+whether or not they are disabled.
+)
+item(tt(-o))(
+Names of shell options (see
+ifzman(zmanref(zshoptions))\
+ifnzman(noderef(Options))\
+).
+)
+item(tt(-v))(
+Names of any variable defined in the shell.
+)
+item(tt(-N))(
+Names of scalar (non-array) parameters.
+)
+item(tt(-A))(
+Array names.
+)
+item(tt(-I))(
+Names of integer variables.
+)
+item(tt(-O))(
+Names of read-only variables.
+)
+item(tt(-p))(
+Names of parameters used by the shell (including special parameters).
+)
+item(tt(-Z))(
+Names of shell special parameters.
+)
+item(tt(-E))(
+Names of environment variables.
+)
+item(tt(-n))(
+Named directories.
+)
+item(tt(-b))(
+Key binding names.
+)
+item(tt(-j))(
+Job names:  the first word of the job leader's command line.  This is useful
+with the tt(kill) builtin.
+)
+item(tt(-r))(
+Names of running jobs.
+)
+item(tt(-z))(
+Names of suspended jobs.
+)
+item(tt(-u))(
+User names.
+)
+enditem()
+texinode(Flags with Arguments)(Control Flags)(Simple Flags)(Option Flags)
+subsect(Flags with Arguments)
+These have user supplied arguments to determine how the list of
+completions is to be made up:
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(-k) var(array))(
+Names taken from the elements of tt($)var(array) (note that the `tt($)'
+does not appear on the command line).
+Alternatively, the argument var(array) itself may be a set
+of space- or comma-separated values in parentheses, in which any
+delimiter may be escaped with a backslash; in this case the argument
+should be quoted.  For example,
+
+nofill(tt(compctl -k "(cputime filesize datasize stacksize
+    coredumpsize resident descriptors)" limit))
+)
+item(tt(-g) var(globstring))(
+The var(globstring) is expanded using filename globbing; it should be
+quoted to protect it from immediate expansion. The resulting
+filenames are taken as the possible completions.  Use `tt(*(/))' instead of
+`tt(*/)' for directories.  The tt(fignore) special parameter is not
+applied to the resulting files.  More than one pattern may be given
+separated by blanks. (Note that brace expansion is em(not) part of
+globbing.  Use the syntax `tt((either|or))' to match alternatives.)
+)
+item(tt(-s) var(subststring))(
+The var(subststring) is split into words and these words are than
+expanded using all shell expansion mechanisms (see
+ifzman(zmanref(zshexpn))\
+ifnzman(noderef(Expansion))\
+).  The resulting words are taken as possible
+completions.  The tt(fignore) special parameter is not applied to the
+resulting files.  Note that tt(-g) is faster for filenames.
+)
+item(tt(-K) var(function))(
+Call the given function to get the completions.  The function is
+passed two arguments: the prefix and the suffix of the word on which
+completion is to be attempted, in other words those characters before
+the cursor position, and those from the cursor position onwards.  The
+whole command line can be accessed with the tt(-c) and tt(-l) flags
+of the tt(read) builtin.  The
+function should set the variable tt(reply) to an array containing
+the completions (one completion per element); note that tt(reply)
+should not be made local to the function.  From such a function the
+command line can be accessed with the tt(-c) and tt(-l) flags to
+the tt(read) builtin.  For example,
+
+nofill(tt(function whoson { reply=(`users`); }
+compctl -K whoson talk))
+
+completes only logged-on users after `tt(talk)'.  Note that `tt(whoson)' must
+return an array, so `tt(reply=`users`)' would be incorrect.
+)
+item(tt(-H) var(num pattern))(
+The possible completions are taken from the last var(num) history
+lines.  Only words matching var(pattern) are taken.  If var(num) is
+zero or negative the whole history is searched and if var(pattern) is
+the empty string all words are taken (as with `tt(*)').  A typical
+use is
+
+nofill(tt(compctl -D -f PLUS() -H 0 ''))
+
+which forces completion to look back in the history list for a word if
+no filename matches.
+)
+enditem()
+texinode(Control Flags)()(Flags with Arguments)(Option Flags)
+subsect(Control Flags)
+These do not directly specify types of name to be completed, but
+manipulate the options that do:
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(-Q))(
+This instructs the shell not to quote any metacharacters in the possible
+completions.  Normally the results of a completion are inserted into
+the command line with any metacharacters quoted so that they are
+interpreted as normal characters.  This is appropriate for filenames
+and ordinary strings.  However, for special effects, such as inserting
+a backquoted expression from a completion array (tt(-k)) so that
+the expression will not be evaluated until the complete line is
+executed, this option must be used.
+)
+item(tt(-P) var(prefix))(
+The var(prefix) is inserted just before the completed string; any
+initial part already typed will be completed and the whole var(prefix)
+ignored for completion purposes.  For example,
+
+nofill(tt(compctl -j -P "%" kill))
+
+inserts a `%' after the kill command and then completes job names.
+)
+item(tt(-S) var(suffix))(
+When a completion is found the var(suffix) is inserted after
+the completed string.  In the case of menu completion the suffix is
+inserted immediately, but it is still possible to cycle through the
+list of completions by repeatedly hitting the same key.
+)
+item(tt(-W) var(file-prefix))(
+With directory var(file-prefix):  for command, file, directory and
+globbing completion (options tt(-c), tt(-f), tt(-/), tt(-g)), the file
+prefix is implicitly added in front of the completion.  For example,
+
+nofill(tt(compctl -/ -W ~/Mail maildirs))
+
+completes any subdirectories to any depth beneath the directory
+tt(~/Mail), although that prefix does not appear on the command line.
+)
+item(tt(-q))(
+If used with a suffix as specified by the tt(-S) option, this
+causes the suffix to be removed if the next character typed is a blank
+or does not insert anything (the same rule as used for the
+tt(AUTO_REMOVE_SLASH) option).  The option is most useful for list
+separators (comma, colon, etc.).
+)
+item(tt(-l) var(cmd))(
+This option cannot be combined with any other.  It restricts the range
+of command line words that are considered to be arguments.  If
+combined with one of the extended completion patterns `tt(p[)...tt(])',
+`tt(r[)...tt(])', or `tt(R[)...tt(])'  (see noderef(Extended Completion)
+below) the range is restricted to the range of arguments
+specified in the brackets.  Completion is then performed as if these
+had been given as arguments to the var(cmd) supplied with the
+option. If the var(cmd) string is empty the first word in the range
+is instead taken as the command name, and command name completion
+performed on the first word in the range.  For example,
+
+nofill(tt(compctl -x 'r[-exec,;]' -l '' -- find))
+
+completes arguments between `tt(-exec)' and the following `tt(;)' (or the end
+of the command line if there is no such string) as if they were
+a separate command line.
+)
+item(tt(-U))(
+Use the whole list of possible completions, whether or not they
+actually match the word on the command line.  The word typed so far
+will be deleted.  This is most useful with a function (given by the
+tt(-K) option) which can examine the word components passed to it
+(or via the tt(read) builtin's tt(-c) and tt(-l) flags) and
+use its own criteria to decide what matches.  If there is no
+completion, the original word is retained.
+)
+item(tt(-y) var(func-or-var))(
+The list provided by var(func-or-var) is displayed instead of the list
+of completions whenever a listing is required; the actual completions
+to be inserted are not affected.  It can be provided in two
+ways. Firstly, if var(func-or-var) begins with a tt($) it defines a
+variable, or if it begins with a left parenthesis a literal
+array, which contains the list.  A variable may have been set by a
+call to a function using the tt(-K) option.  Otherwise it contains the
+name of a function which will be executed to create the list.  The
+function will be passed as an argument list all matching completions,
+including prefixes and suffixes expanded in full, and should set the
+array var(reply) to the result.  In both cases, the display list will
+only be retrieved after a complete list of matches has been created.
+
+Note that the returned list does not have to correspond, even in
+length, to the original set of matches, and may be passed as a scalar
+instead of an array.  No special formatting of characters is
+performed on the output in this case; in particular, newlines are
+printed literally and if they appear output in columns is suppressed.
+)
+item(tt(-X) var(explanation))(
+Print var(explanation) when trying completion on the current set of
+options. A `tt(%n)' in this string is replaced by the number of matches.
+The explanation only appears if completion was tried and there was
+no unique match, or when listing completions.
+)
+item(tt(-Y) var(explanation))(
+Identical to tt(-X), except that the var(explanation) first undergoes
+expansion following the usual rules for strings in double quotes.
+The expansion will be carried out after any functions are called for
+the tt(-K) or tt(-y) options, allowing them to set variables.
+)
+enditem()
+texinode(Alternative Completion)(Extended Completion)(Option Flags)(Programmable Completion)
+sect(Alternative Completion)
+startlist()
+list(tt(compctl) [ tt(-CDT) ] var(options) tt(PLUS()) var(options) [ tt(PLUS()) ... ] \
+[ tt(PLUS()) ] var(command) ...)
+endlist()
+
+The form with `tt(PLUS())' specifies alternative options. Completion is
+tried with the options before the first `tt(PLUS())'. If this produces no
+matches completion is tried with the flags after the `tt(PLUS())' and so on. If
+there are no flags after the last `tt(PLUS())' and a match has not been found
+up to that point, default completion is tried.
+texinode(Extended Completion)(Example)(Alternative Completion)(Programmable Completion)
+sect(Extended Completion)
+startlist()
+list(tt(compctl) [ tt(-CDT) ] var(options) \
+tt(-x) var(pattern) var(options) tt(-) ... tt(--) \
+[ var(command) ... ])
+list(tt(compctl) [ tt(-CDT) ] var(options) \
+[ tt(-x) var(pattern) var(options) tt(-) ... tt(--) ] \
+[ tt(PLUS()) var(options) [ tt(-x) ... tt(--) ] ... [tt(PLUS())] ] \
+[ var(command) ... ])
+endlist()
+
+The form with `tt(-x)' specifies extended completion for the
+commands given; as shown, it may be combined with alternative
+completion using `tt(PLUS())'.  Each var(pattern) is examined in turn; when a
+match is found, the corresponding var(options), as described in
+noderef(Option Flags) above, are used to generate possible
+completions.  If no var(pattern) matches, the var(options) given
+before the tt(-x) are used.
+
+Note that each pattern should be supplied as a single argument and
+should be quoted to prevent expansion of metacharacters by the
+shell.
+
+A var(pattern) is built of sub-patterns separated by commas; it
+matches if at least one of these sub-patterns matches (they are
+`or'ed). These sub-patterns are in turn composed of other
+sub-patterns separated by white spaces which match if all of the
+sub-patterns match (they are `and'ed).  An element of the
+sub-patterns is of the form `var(c)tt([)...tt(][)...tt(])', where the pairs of
+brackets may be repeated as often as necessary, and matches if any of
+the sets of brackets match (an `or').  The example below makes this
+clearer.
+
+The elements may be any of the following:
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(s[)var(string)tt(])...)(
+Matches if the current word on the command line starts with
+one of the strings given in brackets.  The var(string) is not removed
+and is not part of the completion.
+)
+item(tt(S[)var(string)tt(])...)(
+Like tt(s[)var(string)tt(]) except that the var(string) is part of the
+completion.
+)
+item(tt(p[)var(from)tt(,)var(to)tt(])...)(
+Matches if the number of the current word is between one of
+the var(from) and var(to) pairs inclusive. The comma and var(to)
+are optional; var(to) defaults to the same value as var(from).  The
+numbers may be negative: tt(-)var(n) refers to the var(n)'th last word
+on the line.
+)
+item(tt(c[)var(offset)tt(,)var(string)tt(])...)(
+Matches if the var(string) matches the word offset by
+var(offset) from the current word position.  Usually var(offset)
+will be negative.
+)
+item(tt(C[)var(offset)tt(,)var(pattern)tt(])...)(
+Like tt(c) but using pattern matching instead.
+)
+item(tt(w[)var(index)tt(,)var(string)tt(])...)(
+Matches if the word in position var(index) is equal
+to the corresponding var(string).  Note that the word count is made
+after any alias expansion.
+)
+item(tt(W[)var(index)tt(,)var(pattern)tt(])...)(
+Like tt(w) but using pattern matching instead.
+)
+item(tt(n[)var(index)tt(,)var(string)tt(])...)(
+Matches if the current word contains var(string).  Anything up to and
+including the var(index)th occurrence of this string will not be
+considered part of the completion, but the rest will.  var(index) may
+be negative to count from the end: in most cases, var(index) will be
+1 or -1.  For example,
+
+nofill(tt(compctl -s '`users`' -x 'n[1,@]' -k hosts -- talk))
+
+will usually complete usernames, but if you insert an tt(@) after the
+name, names from the array var(hosts) (assumed to contain hostnames,
+though you must make the array yourself) will be completed.  Other
+commands such as tt(rcp) can be handled similarly.
+)
+item(tt(N[)var(index)tt(,)var(string)tt(])...)(
+Like tt(n) except that the string will be
+taken as a character class.  Anything up to and including the
+var(index)th occurrence of any of the characters in var(string)
+will not be considered part of the completion.
+)
+item(tt(m[)var(min)tt(,)var(max)tt(])...)(
+Matches if the total number of words lies between var(min) and
+var(max) inclusive.
+)
+item(tt(r[)var(str1)tt(,)var(str2)tt(])...)(
+Matches if the cursor is after a word with prefix var(str1).  If there
+is also a word with prefix var(str2) on the command line it matches
+only if the cursor is before this word.
+)
+item(tt(R[)var(str1)tt(,)var(str2)tt(])...)(
+Like tt(r) but using pattern matching instead.
+)
+enditem()
+texinode(Example)()(Extended Completion)(Programmable Completion)
+sect(Example)
+nofill(tt(compctl -u -x 's[tt(PLUS())] c[-1,-f],s[-f+PLUS()]' -g '~/Mail/*(:t)' \ 
+    - 's[-f],c[-1,-f]' -f -- mail))
+
+This is to be interpreted as follows:
+
+If the current command is tt(mail), then
+
+indent(
+if ((the current word begins with tt(PLUS()) and the previous word is tt(-f))
+or (the current word begins with tt(-f+PLUS()))), then complete the
+non-directory part (the `tt(:t)' glob modifier) of files in the directory
+tt(~/Mail); else
+
+if the current word begins with tt(-f) or the previous word was tt(-f), then
+complete any file; else
+
+complete user names.
+)
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/cond.yo b/Doc/Zsh/cond.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..0ff49b187
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/cond.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,158 @@
+texinode(Conditional Expressions)(Compatibility)(Arithmetic Evaluation)(Top)
+chapter(Conditional Expressions)
+ifzman(\
+sect(Conditional Expressions)
+)\
+cindex(conditional expressions)
+cindex(expressions, conditional)
+A em(conditional expression) is used with the tt([[)
+compound command to test attributes of files and to compare strings.
+Each expression can be constructed from one or more
+of the following unary or binary expressions:
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(-a) var(file))(
+true if var(file) exists.
+)
+item(tt(-b) var(file))(
+true if var(file) exists and is a block special file.
+)
+item(tt(-c) var(file))(
+true if var(file) exists and is a character special file.
+)
+item(tt(-d) var(file))(
+true if var(file) exists and is a directory.
+)
+item(tt(-e) var(file))(
+true if var(file) exists.
+)
+item(tt(-f) var(file))(
+true if var(file) exists and is a regular file.
+)
+item(tt(-g) var(file))(
+true if var(file) exists and has its setgid bit set.
+)
+item(tt(-h) var(file))(
+true if var(file) exists and is a symbolic link.
+)
+item(tt(-k) var(file))(
+true if var(file) exists and has its sticky bit set.
+)
+item(tt(-n) var(string))(
+true if length of var(string) is non-zero.
+)
+item(tt(-o) var(option))(
+true if option named var(option) is on.  var(option)
+may be a single character, in which case it is a single letter option name.
+(See noderef(Specifying Options).)
+)
+item(tt(-p) var(file))(
+true if var(file) exists and is a FIFO special file (named pipe).
+)
+item(tt(-r) var(file))(
+true if var(file) exists and is readable by current process.
+)
+item(tt(-s) var(file))(
+true if var(file) exists and has size greater than zero.
+)
+item(tt(-t) var(fd))(
+true if file descriptor number var(fd)
+is open and associated with a terminal device.
+(note: var(fd) is not optional)
+)
+item(tt(-u) var(file))(
+true if var(file) exists and has its setuid bit set.
+)
+item(tt(-w) var(file))(
+true if var(file) exists and is writable by current process.
+)
+item(tt(-x) var(file))(
+true if var(file) exists and is executable by current process.
+If var(file) exists and is a directory, then the current process
+has permission to search in the directory.
+)
+item(tt(-z) var(string))(
+true if length of var(string) is zero.
+)
+item(tt(-L) var(file))(
+true if var(file) exists and is a symbolic link.
+)
+item(tt(-O) var(file))(
+true if var(file) exists and is owned by the effective user ID of this process.
+)
+item(tt(-G) var(file))(
+true if var(file) exists and its group matches
+the effective group ID of this process.
+)
+item(tt(-S) var(file))(
+true if var(file) exists and is a socket.
+)
+item(tt(-N) var(file))(
+true if var(file) exists and its access time is
+not newer than its modification time.
+)
+item(var(file1) tt(-nt) var(file2))(
+true if var(file1) exists and is newer than var(file2).
+)
+item(var(file1) tt(-ot) var(file2))(
+true if var(file1) exists and is older than var(file2).
+)
+item(var(file1) tt(-ef) var(file2))(
+true if var(file1) and var(file2) exist and refer to the same file.
+)
+xitem(var(string) tt(=) var(pattern))
+item(var(string) tt(==) var(pattern))(
+true if var(string) matches var(pattern).
+The `tt(==)' form is the preferred one.  The `tt(=)' form is for
+backward compatibility and should be considered obsolete.
+)
+item(var(string) tt(!=) var(pattern))(
+true if var(string) does not match var(pattern).
+)
+item(var(string1) tt(<) var(string2))(
+true if var(string1) comes before var(string2)
+based on ASCII value of their characters.
+)
+item(var(string1) tt(>) var(string2))(
+true if var(string1) comes after var(string2)
+based on ASCII value of their characters.
+)
+item(var(exp1) tt(-eq) var(exp2))(
+true if var(exp1) is numerically equal to var(exp2).
+)
+item(var(exp1) tt(-ne) var(exp2))(
+true if var(exp1) is numerically not equal to var(exp2).
+)
+item(var(exp1) tt(-lt) var(exp2))(
+true if var(exp1) is numerically less than var(exp2).
+)
+item(var(exp1) tt(-gt) var(exp2))(
+true if var(exp1) is numerically greater than var(exp2).
+)
+item(var(exp1) tt(-le) var(exp2))(
+true if var(exp1) is numerically less than or equal to var(exp2).
+)
+item(var(exp1) tt(-ge) var(exp2))(
+true if var(exp1) is numerically greater than or equal to var(exp2).
+)
+item(tt(LPAR()) var(exp) tt(RPAR()))(
+true if var(exp) is true.
+)
+item(tt(!) var(exp))(
+true if var(exp) is false.
+)
+item(var(exp1) tt(&&) var(exp2))(
+true if var(exp1) and var(exp2) are both true.
+)
+item(var(exp1) tt(||) var(exp2))(
+true if either var(exp1) or var(exp2) is true.
+)
+enditem()
+
+In each of the above expressions, if
+var(file) is of the form `tt(/dev/fd/)var(n)',
+where var(n) is an integer,
+then the test applied to the open file whose
+descriptor number is var(n),
+even if the underlying system does not support
+the tt(/dev/fd) directory.
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/exec.yo b/Doc/Zsh/exec.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..0d53b14b8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/exec.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,25 @@
+texinode(Command Execution)(Functions)(Redirection)(Top)
+chapter(Command Execution)
+ifzman(\
+sect(Command Execution)
+)\
+cindex(command execution)
+cindex(execution, of commands)
+If a command name contains no slashes, the shell attempts to locate
+it.  If there exists a shell function by that name, the function
+is invoked as described in noderef(Functions).  If there exists
+a shell builtin by that name, the builtin is invoked.
+
+vindex(path, use of)
+Otherwise, the shell searches each element of tt($path) for a
+directory containing an executable file by that name.  If the
+search is unsuccessful, the shell prints an error message and returns
+a nonzero exit status.
+
+If execution fails because the file is not in executable format,
+and the file is not a directory, it is assumed to be a shell
+script.  tt(/bin/sh) is spawned to execute it.  If the program
+is a file beginning with `tt(#!)', the remainder of the first line
+specifies an interpreter for the program.  The shell will
+execute the specified interpreter on operating systems that do
+not handle this executable format in the kernel.
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/expn.yo b/Doc/Zsh/expn.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..99844b42a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/expn.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,1052 @@
+texinode(Expansion)(Parameters)(Restricted Shell)(Top)
+chapter(Expansion)
+cindex(expansion)
+sect(Description)
+The types of expansions performed are
+
+startlist()
+list(em(history expansion))
+list(em(alias expansion))
+list(em(process substitution))
+list(em(parameter expansion))
+list(em(command substitution))
+list(em(arithmetic expansion))
+list(em(brace expansion))
+list(em(filename expansion))
+list(em(filename generation))
+endlist()
+
+Expansion is done in the above specified order in five steps.  The
+first is em(history expansion), which is only performed in
+interactive shells.  The next step is em(alias expansion), which is
+done right before the command line is parsed.  They are followed by
+em(process substitution), em(parameter expansion), em(command
+substitution), em(arithmetic expansion) and em(brace expansion)
+which are performed in one step in left-to-right fashion.  After
+these expansions, all unquoted occurrences of the characters `tt(\)',
+`tt(')' and `tt(")' are removed, and the result is subjected to
+em(filename expansion) followed by em(filename generation).
+
+If the tt(SH_FILE_EXPANSION) option is set, the order of expansion is modified
+for compatibility with bf(sh) and bf(ksh).  em(Filename expansion)
+is performed immediately after em(alias substitution),
+preceding the set of five substitutions mentioned above.
+startmenu()
+menu(History Expansion)
+menu(Process Substitution)
+menu(Parameter Expansion)
+menu(Command Substitution)
+menu(Arithmetic Expansion)
+menu(Brace Expansion)
+menu(Filename Expansion)
+menu(Filename Generation)
+endmenu()
+texinode(History Expansion)(Process Substitution)()(Expansion)
+sect(History Expansion)
+cindex(history)
+cindex(history expansion)
+cindex(expansion, history)
+History expansion allows you to use words from previous command
+lines in the command line you are typing.  This simplifies spelling
+corrections and the repetition of complicated commands or arguments.
+Command lines are saved in the history list, the size of which
+is controlled by the tt(HISTSIZE)
+vindex(HISTSIZE, use of)
+variable.  The most recent command is retained in any case.
+A history expansion begins with the first character of the
+tt(histchars) parameter which is `tt(!)'
+by default and may occur anywhere on the command line; history
+expansions do not nest.  The `tt(!)' can be escaped with `tt(\)'
+or can be enclosed between a pair of single quotes (tt('')) to suppress
+its special meaning. Double quotes will em(not) work for this.
+
+Input lines containing history expansions are echoed on the
+terminal after being expanded, but before any other
+expansions take place or the command gets executed.
+startmenu()
+menu(Event Designators)
+menu(Word Designators)
+menu(Modifiers)
+endmenu()
+texinode(Event Designators)(Word Designators)()(History Expansion)
+subsect(Event Designators)
+cindex(history event designators)
+cindex(event designators, history)
+An event designator is a reference to a command-line entry in
+the history list.
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(!))(
+Start a history expansion, except when followed by a blank, newline,
+`tt(=)' or `tt(LPAR())'.
+)
+item(tt(!!))(
+Refer to the previous command.
+By itself, this expansion
+repeats the previous command.
+)
+item(tt(!)var(n))(
+Refer to command-line var(n).
+)
+item(tt(!-)var(n))(
+Refer to the current command-line minus var(n).
+)
+item(tt(!)var(str))(
+Refer to the most recent command starting with var(str).
+)
+item(tt(!?)var(str)[tt(?)])(
+Refer to the most recent command containing var(str).
+)
+item(tt(!#))(
+Refer to the current command line typed in so far.  The line is
+treated as if it were complete up to and including the word before the
+one with the `tt(!#)' reference.
+)
+item(tt(!{)...tt(}))(
+Insulate a history reference from adjacent characters (if necessary).
+)
+enditem()
+texinode(Word Designators)(Modifiers)(Event Designators)(History Expansion)
+subsect(Word Designators)
+cindex(history word designators)
+cindex(word designators, history)
+A word designator indicates which word or words of a given command line will
+be included in a history reference.  A `tt(:)'
+separates the event specification from the word designator.
+It can be omitted if the word designator begins with a
+`tt(^)', `tt($)', `tt(*)', `tt(-)' or `tt(%)'.
+Word designators include:
+
+startsitem()
+sitem(tt(0))(The first input word (command).)
+sitem(var(n))(The var(n)th argument.)
+sitem(tt(^))(The first argument.  That is, tt(1).)
+sitem(tt($))(The last argument.)
+sitem(tt(%))(The word matched by (the most recent) tt(?)var(str) search.)
+sitem(var(x)tt(-)var(y))(A range of words; var(x) defaults to tt(0).)
+sitem(tt(*))(All the arguments, or a null value if there are none.)
+sitem(var(x)tt(*))(Abbreviates `var(x)tt(-$)'.)
+sitem(var(x)tt(-))(Like `var(x)tt(*)' but omitting word tt($).)
+endsitem()
+
+Note that a `tt(%)' word designator will only work when used as
+`tt(!%)', `tt(!:%)' or `tt(!?)var(str)tt(?:%)',
+and only when used after a tt(!?) expansion.  Anything else will result
+in an error, although the error may not be the most obvious one.
+texinode(Modifiers)()(Word Designators)(History Expansion)
+subsect(Modifiers)
+cindex(modifiers, history)
+cindex(history modifiers)
+After the optional word designator, you can add
+a sequence of one or more of the following modifiers,
+each preceded by a `tt(:)'.  These modifiers also work on the result
+of em(filename generation) and em(parameter expansion), except where
+noted.
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(h))(
+Remove a trailing pathname component, leaving the head.
+)
+item(tt(r))(
+Remove a trailing suffix of the form `tt(.)var(xxx)', leaving the basename.
+)
+item(tt(e))(
+Remove all but the suffix.
+)
+item(tt(t))(
+Remove all leading pathname components, leaving the tail.
+)
+item(tt(p))(
+Print the new command but do not execute it.  Only works with history
+expansion.
+)
+item(tt(q))(
+Quote the substituted words, escaping further substitutions.  Only
+works with history expansion.
+)
+item(tt(x))(
+Like tt(q), but break into words at each blank.
+)
+item(tt(l))(
+Convert the words to all lowercase.
+)
+item(tt(u))(
+Convert the words to all uppercase.
+)
+item(tt(f))(
+(This and the following
+tt(F), tt(w) and tt(W) modifier only work with parameter and
+filename expansion.)
+Repeats the immediately (without a colon) following modifier until the
+resulting word doesn't change any more.
+)
+item(tt(F:)var(expr)tt(:))(
+Like tt(f), but repeats only var(n) times if the expression
+var(expr) evaluates to var(n).  Any character can be used instead of
+the `tt(:)', if any of `tt(LPAR())', `tt([)', or `tt({)'
+is used as the opening delimiter
+the second one has to be 'tt(RPAR())', `tt(])', or `tt(})' respectively.
+)
+item(tt(w))(
+Makes the immediately following modifier work on each word in the
+string.
+)
+item(tt(W:)var(sep)tt(:))(
+Like tt(w) but words are considered to be the parts of the string
+that are separated by var(sep). Any character can be used instead of
+the `tt(:)'; opening parentheses are handled specially, see above.
+)
+item(tt(s/)var(l)tt(/)var(r)[tt(/)])(
+Substitute var(r) for var(l) as described below.
+Unless preceded immediately by a tt(g), with no colon between,
+the substitution is done only for the
+first string that matches var(l).  For arrays and filename
+expansion, this applies to each word of the expanded text.
+)
+item(tt(&))(
+Repeat the previous tt(s) substitution.  Like tt(s), may be preceded
+immediately by a tt(g).  In variable expansion the tt(&) must appear
+inside braces, and in filename expansion it must be quoted with a
+backslash.
+)
+enditem()
+
+The tt(s/l/r/) substitution works as follows.  The left-hand side of
+substitutions are not regular expressions, but character strings.  Any
+character can be used as the delimiter in place of `tt(/)'.  A
+backslash quotes the delimiter character.  The character `tt(&)', in
+the right-hand-side var(r), is replaced by the text from the
+left-hand-side var(l).  The `tt(&)' can be quoted with a backslash.  A
+null var(l) uses the previous string either from the previous var(l)
+or from the contextual scan string var(s) from `tt(!?)var(s)'.  You can
+omit the rightmost delimiter if a newline immediately follows var(r);
+the rightmost `tt(?)' in a context scan can similarly be omitted.
+Note the same record of the last var(l) and var(r) is maintained
+across all forms of expansion.
+
+By default, a history reference with no event specification refers to the same
+line as the last history reference on that command line, unless it is the
+first history reference in a command.  In that case, a history reference
+with no event specification always refers to the previous command.  However,
+if the option tt(CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY) is set,
+pindex(CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY, use of)
+then history reference with no
+event specification will em(always) refer to the previous command.
+
+For example, `tt(!!:1)'
+will always refer to the first word of the previous command, and `tt(!!$)'
+will always refer to the last word of the previous command.  And with
+tt(CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY) set, then `tt(!:1)' and `tt(!$)'
+will function in the same manner as `tt(!!:1)' and `tt(!!$)',
+respectively.  However, if tt(CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY) is unset, then
+`tt(!:1)' and `tt(!$)'
+will refer to the first and last words respectively, of the last command
+referenced on the current command line.  However, if they are the first history
+reference on the command line, then they refer to the previous command.
+
+The character sequence `tt(^)var(foo)tt(^)var(bar)'
+repeats the last command, replacing the string var(foo) with var(bar).
+
+If the shell encounters the character sequence `tt(!")'
+in the input, the history mechanism is temporarily disabled until
+the current list is fully parsed.  The `tt(!")'
+is removed from the input, and any subsequent `tt(!)'
+characters have no special significance.
+
+A less convenient but more comprehensible
+form of command history support
+is provided by the tt(fc) builtin.
+findex(fc, use of)
+texinode(Process Substitution)(Parameter Expansion)(History Expansion)(Expansion)
+sect(Process Substitution)
+cindex(process substitution)
+cindex(substitution, process)
+Each command argument of the form
+`tt(<LPAR())var(list)tt(RPAR())',
+`tt(>LPAR())var(list)tt(RPAR())' or
+`tt(=LPAR())var(list)tt(RPAR())'
+is subject to process substitution.
+In the case of the tt(<) or tt(>) forms, the shell will run process
+var(list) asynchronously, connected to a named pipe (FIFO).
+The name of this pipe will become the argument to the command.
+If the form with tt(>)
+is selected then writing on this file will provide input for var(list).
+If tt(<) is used, then the file passed as an argument will
+be a named pipe connected to the output of the var(list) process.
+For example,
+
+nofill(tt(paste <LPAR()cut -f1) var(file1)tt(RPAR() <LPAR()cut -f3) var(file2)tt(RPAR() | tee >LPAR())var(process1)tt(RPAR() >LPAR())var(process2)tt(RPAR() >/dev/null))
+
+cuts fields 1 and 3 from the files var(file1) and var(file2) respectively,
+pastes the results together, and sends it to the processes
+var(process1) and var(process2).
+Note that the file, which is passed as an argument to the command,
+is a system pipe, so programs that expect to lseek (see manref(lseek)(2))
+on the file will not work.
+Also note that the previous example can be more compactly and
+efficiently written as:
+
+nofill(tt(paste <LPAR()cut -f1) var(file1)tt(RPAR() <LPAR()cut -f3) var(file2)tt(RPAR() > >LPAR())var(process1)tt(RPAR() > >LPAR())var(process2)tt(RPAR()))
+
+The shell uses pipes instead of FIFOs to implement the latter
+two process substitutions in the above example.
+
+If tt(=) is used,
+then the file passed as an argument will be the name
+of a temporary file containing the output of the var(list)
+process.  This may be used instead of the tt(<)
+form for a program that expects to lseek (see manref(lseek)(2))
+on the input file.
+texinode(Parameter Expansion)(Command Substitution)(Process Substitution)(Expansion)
+sect(Parameter Expansion)
+cindex(parameter expansion)
+cindex(expansion, parameter)
+The character `tt($)' is used to introduce parameter expansions.
+See
+ifzman(\
+zmanref(zshparam)
+)\
+ifnzman(\
+noderef(Parameters)
+)\
+for a description of parameters.
+In the expansions discussed below that require a pattern, the form of
+the pattern is the same as that used for filename generation;
+see noderef(Filename Generation).  In addition to the following
+operations, the file modifiers described in
+noderef(Modifiers) in noderef(History Expansion) can be
+applied:  for example, tt(${i:s/foo/bar/}) performs string
+substitution on the value of parameter tt($i).
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(${)var(name)tt(}))(
+The value, if any, of the parameter var(name) is substituted.
+The braces are required if var(name) is followed by
+a letter, digit, or underscore that is not to be interpreted
+as part of its name.
+
+If var(name) is an array parameter, then the values of each
+element of var(name) is substituted, one element per word.
+Otherwise, the expansion results in one word only; no field
+splitting is done on the result unless the tt(SH_WORD_SPLIT)
+option is set.
+)
+item(tt(${PLUS())var(name)tt(}))(
+If var(name) is the name of a set parameter `tt(1)' is substituted,
+otherwise `tt(0)' is substituted.
+)
+item(tt(${)var(name)tt(:-)var(word)tt(}))(
+If var(name) is set and is non-null then substitute its
+value; otherwise substitute var(word). If var(name) is
+missing, substitute var(word).
+)
+item(tt(${)var(name)tt(:=)var(word)tt(}))(
+If var(name) is unset or is null then
+set it to var(word); the value of the parameter is then
+substituted.
+)
+item(tt(${)var(name)tt(:?)var(word)tt(}))(
+If var(name) is set and is non-null, then substitute
+its value; otherwise, print var(word) and exit from the shell.
+If var(word) is omitted, then a standard message is printed.
+)
+item(tt(${)var(name)tt(:PLUS())var(word)tt(}))(
+If var(name) is set and is non-null then substitute
+var(word); otherwise substitute nothing.
+)
+enditem()
+
+If the colon is omitted from one of the above expressions
+containing a colon, then the shell only checks whether
+var(name) is set or not, not whether it is null.
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(${)var(name)tt(::=)var(word)tt(}))(
+Set var(name) to var(word); the value of the parameter is then
+substituted.
+)
+xitem(tt(${)var(name)tt(#)var(pattern)tt(}))
+item(tt(${)var(name)tt(##)var(pattern)tt(}))(
+If the var(pattern) matches the beginning of the value of
+var(name), then substitute the value of var(name) with
+the matched portion deleted; otherwise, just
+substitute the value of var(name).  In the first
+form, the smallest matching pattern is preferred;
+in the second form, the largest matching pattern is
+preferred. If var(name) is an array and the substitution
+is not quoted or the tt((@)) flag or the `var(name)tt([@])' syntax
+is used, matching is performed on each array elements separately.
+)
+xitem(tt(${)var(name)tt(%)var(pattern)tt(}))
+item(tt(${)var(name)tt(%%)var(pattern)tt(}))(
+If the var(pattern) matches the end of the value of
+var(name), then substitute the value of var(name) with
+the matched portion deleted; otherwise, just
+substitute the value of var(name).  In the first
+form, the smallest matching pattern is preferred;
+in the second form, the largest matching pattern is
+preferred. If var(name) is an array and the substitution
+is not quoted or the tt((@)) flag or the `var(name)tt([@])' syntax
+is used, matching is performed on each array elements separately.
+)
+item(tt(${)var(name)tt(:#)var(pattern)tt(}))(
+If the var(pattern) matches the value of var(name), then substitute
+the empty string; otherwise, just substitute the value of var(name).
+If var(name) is an array and the substitution
+is not quoted or the tt((@)) flag or the `var(name)tt([@])' syntax
+is used, matching is performed on each array elements separately, and
+the matched array elements are removed (use the tt((M)) flag to
+remove the non-matched elements).
+)
+item(tt(${#)var(spec)tt(}))(
+If var(spec) is one of the above substitutions, substitute
+the length in characters of the result instead of
+the result itself.  If var(spec) is an array expression,
+substitute the number of elements of the result.
+)
+item(tt(${^)var(spec)tt(}))(
+pindex(RC_EXPAND_PARAM, use of)
+cindex(array expansion style, rc)
+cindex(rc, array expansion style)
+Turn on the tt(RC_EXPAND_PARAM) option for the
+evaluation of var(spec); if the `tt(^)' is doubled, turn it off.
+When this option is set, array expansions of the form
+`var(foo)tt(${)var(xx)tt(})var(bar)',
+where the parameter var(xx)
+is set to tt(LPAR())var(a b c)tt(RPAR()), are substituted with
+`var(fooabar foobbar foocbar)' instead of the default
+`var(fooa b cbar)'.
+
+Internally, each such expansion is converted into the
+equivalent list for brace expansion.  E.g., tt(${^var}) becomes
+tt({$var[1],$var[2],)...tt(}), and is processed as described in
+noderef(Brace Expansion) above.
+If word splitting is also in effect the
+tt($var[)var(N)tt(]) may themselves be split into different list
+elements.
+)
+item(tt(${=)var(spec)tt(}))(
+pindex(SH_WORD_SPLIT, use of)
+cindex(field splitting, sh style)
+cindex(sh, field splitting style)
+Turn on the tt(SH_WORD_SPLIT) option for the
+evaluation of var(spec); if the `tt(=)' is doubled, turn it off.
+vindex(IFS, use of)
+When this option is set, parameter values are split into
+separate words using tt(IFS) as a delimiter
+before substitution.
+This is done by default in most other shells.
+)
+item(tt(${~)var(spec)tt(}))(
+pindex(GLOB_SUBST)
+Turn on the tt(GLOB_SUBST) option for the evaluation of
+var(spec); if the `tt(~)' is doubled, turn it off.  When this option is
+set, any pattern characters resulting
+from the substitution become eligible for file expansion and filename
+generation.
+)
+enditem()
+
+If a tt(${)...tt(}) type parameter expression or a
+tt($LPAR())...tt(RPAR()) type command substitution is used in place of
+var(name) above, it is substituted first and the result is used as if
+it were the value of var(name).  Thus it is
+possible to perform nested operations:  tt(${${foo#head}%tail})
+substitues the value of tt($foo) with both tt(head) and tt(tail)
+deleted.  The form with tt($LPAR())...tt(RPAR()) is often useful in
+combination with the flags described next; see the example below.
+subsect(Parameter Expansion Flags)
+cindex(parameter expansion flags)
+cindex(flags, parameter expansion)
+cindex(expansion, parameter, flags)
+If the opening brace is directly followed by an opening parenthesis,
+the string up to the matching closing parenthesis will be taken as a
+list of flags.  Where arguments are valid, any character, or the
+matching pairs `tt(LPAR())...tt(RPAR())', `tt({)...tt(})',
+`tt([)...tt(])', or `tt(<)...tt(>)',  may be used
+in place of the colon as delimiters.  The following flags are supported:
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(A))(
+Create an array parameter with
+tt(${)...tt(:=)...tt(}) or tt(${)...tt(::=)...tt(}).
+Assignment is made before sorting or padding.
+)
+item(tt(@))(
+In double quotes, array elements are put into separate words.
+E.g., `tt("${(@)foo}")' is equivalent to `tt("${foo[@]}")' and
+`tt("${(@)foo[1,2]}")' is the same as `tt("$foo[1]" "$foo[2]")'.
+)
+item(tt(e))(
+Perform em(parameter expansion), em(command substitution) and
+em(arithmetic expansion) on the result. Such expansions can be
+nested but too deep recursion may have unpredictable effects.
+)
+item(tt(o))(
+Sort the resulting words in ascending order.
+)
+item(tt(O))(
+Sort the resulting words in descending order.
+)
+item(tt(i))(
+With tt(o) or tt(O), sort case-independently.
+)
+item(tt(L))(
+Convert all letters in the result to lower case.
+)
+item(tt(U))(
+Convert all letters in the result to upper case.
+)
+item(tt(C))(
+Capitalize the resulting words.
+)
+item(tt(c))(
+With tt(${#)var(name)tt(}), count the total number of characters in an array,
+as if the elements were concatenated with spaces between them.
+)
+item(tt(w))(
+With tt(${#)var(name)tt(}), count words in arrays or strings; the tt(s)
+flag may be used to set a word delimiter.
+)
+item(tt(W))(
+Similar to tt(w) with the difference that empty words between
+repeated delimiters are also counted.
+)
+item(tt(p))(
+Recognize the same escape sequences as the tt(print) builtin
+in string arguments to subsequent flags.
+)
+item(tt(l:)var(expr)tt(::)var(string1)tt(::)var(string2)tt(:))(
+Pad the resulting words on the left.  Each word will be truncated if
+required and placed in a field var(expr) characters wide.  The space
+to the left will be filled with var(string1) (concatenated as often
+as needed) or spaces if var(string1) is not given.  If both
+var(string1) and var(string2) are given, this string will be placed
+exactly once directly to the left of the resulting word.
+)
+item(tt(r:)var(expr)tt(::)var(string1)tt(::)var(string2)tt(:))(
+As tt(l), but pad the words on the right.
+)
+item(tt(j:)var(string)tt(:))(
+Join the words of arrays together using var(string) as a separator.
+pindex(SH_WORD_SPLIT, use of)
+Note that this occurs before field splitting by the tt(SH_WORD_SPLIT)
+option.
+)
+item(tt(F))(
+Join the words of arrays together using newline as a separator.
+This is a shorthand for `tt(pj:\n:)'.
+)
+item(tt(s:)var(string)tt(:))(
+Force field splitting (see the option tt(SH_WORD_SPLIT)) at the
+separator var(string).  Splitting only occurs in places where an
+array value is valid.
+)
+item(tt(f))(
+Split the result of the expansion to lines. This is a shorthand
+for `tt(ps:\n:)'.
+)
+item(tt(S))(
+(This and all remaining flags are used with the tt(${)...tt(#)...tt(}) or
+tt(${)...tt(%)...tt(}) forms.)
+Search substrings as well as beginnings or ends.
+)
+item(tt(I:)var(expr)tt(:))(
+Search the var(expr)th match (where var(expr) evaluates to a number).
+)
+item(tt(M))(
+Include the matched portion in the result.
+)
+item(tt(R))(
+Include the unmatched portion in the result (the em(R)est).
+)
+item(tt(B))(
+Include the index of the beginning of the match in the result.
+)
+item(tt(E))(
+Include the index of the end of the match in the result.
+)
+item(tt(N))(
+Include the length of the match in the result.
+)
+enditem()
+subsect(Example)
+The flag tt(f) is useful to split a double-quoted substitution line by
+line.  For example, `tt("${(f)$LPAR()<)var(file)tt(RPAR()}")'
+will substitue the contents of var(file) divided so that one line is
+supplied per argument to var(cmd).  Compare this with the effect of
+`tt($)tt(LPAR()<)var(file)tt(RPAR())' alone, which divides the file
+up by words, or the same inside double quotes, where the entire
+contents of the file are passed as a single argument.
+texinode(Command Substitution)(Arithmetic Expansion)(Parameter Expansion)(Expansion)
+sect(Command Substitution)
+cindex(command substitution)
+cindex(substitution, command)
+A command enclosed in parentheses
+preceded by a dollar sign, like `tt($LPAR())...tt(RPAR())', or quoted with grave
+accents, like `tt(`)...tt(`)', is replaced with its standard output, with any
+trailing newlines deleted.
+If the substitution is not enclosed in double quotes, the
+output is broken into words using the tt(IFS) parameter.
+vindex(IFS, use of)
+The substitution `tt($LPAR()cat) var(foo)tt(RPAR())' may be replaced
+by the equivalent but faster `tt($LPAR()<)var(foo)tt(RPAR())'.
+In either case, if the option tt(GLOB_SUBST) is set,
+the output is eligible for filename generation.
+texinode(Arithmetic Expansion)(Brace Expansion)(Command Substitution)(Expansion)
+sect(Arithmetic Expansion)
+cindex(arithmetic expansion)
+cindex(expansion, arithmetic)
+A string of the form `tt($[)var(exp)tt(])' or
+`tt($LPAR()LPAR())var(exp)tt(RPAR()RPAR())' is substituted
+with the value of the arithmetic expression var(exp).  var(exp) is
+subjected to em(parameter expansion), em(command substitution)
+and em(arithmetic expansion) before it is evaluated.
+See noderef(Arithmetic Evaluation).
+texinode(Brace Expansion)(Filename Expansion)(Arithmetic Expansion)(Expansion)
+sect(Brace Expansion)
+cindex(brace expansion)
+cindex(expansion, brace)
+A string of the form
+`var(foo)tt({)var(xx)tt(,)var(yy)tt(,)var(zz)tt(})var(bar)'
+is expanded to the individual words
+`var(fooxxbar)', `var(fooyybar)' and `var(foozzbar)'.
+Left-to-right order is preserved.  This construct
+may be nested.  Commas may be quoted in order to
+include them literally in a word.
+
+An expression of the form `tt({)var(n1)tt(..)var(n2)tt(})',
+where var(n1) and var(n2) are integers,
+is expanded to every number between
+var(n1) and var(n2) inclusive.  If either number begins with a
+zero, all the resulting numbers will be padded with leading zeroes to
+that minimum width.  If the numbers are in decreasing order the
+resulting sequence will also be in decreasing order.
+
+If a brace expression matches none of the above forms, it is left
+unchanged, unless the tt(BRACE_CCL) option is set.
+pindex(BRACE_CCL, use of)
+In that case, it is expanded to a sorted list of the individual
+characters between the braces, in the manner of a search set.
+`tt(-)' is treated specially as in a search set, but `tt(^)' or `tt(!)' as
+the first character is treated normally.
+texinode(Filename Expansion)(Filename Generation)(Brace Expansion)(Expansion)
+sect(Filename Expansion)
+cindex(filename expansion)
+cindex(expansion, filename)
+Each word is checked to see if it begins with an unquoted `tt(~)'.
+If it does, then the word up to a `tt(/)',
+or the end of the word if there is no `tt(/)',
+is checked to see if it can be substituted in one of the ways
+described here.  If so, then the `tt(~)' and the checked portion are
+replaced with the appropriate substitute value.
+
+A `tt(~)' by itself is replaced by the value of tt($HOME).
+A `tt(~)' followed by a `tt(PLUS())' or a `tt(-)' is replaced by the value of
+tt($PWD) or tt($OLDPWD), respectively.
+
+A `tt(~)' followed by a number is replaced by the directory at that
+position in the directory stack.
+`tt(~0)' is equivalent to `tt(~PLUS())',
+and `tt(~1)' is the top of the stack.
+`tt(~PLUS())' followed by a number is replaced by the directory at that
+position in the directory stack.
+`tt(~PLUS()0)' is equivalent to `tt(~PLUS())',
+and `tt(~PLUS()1)' is the top of the stack.
+`tt(~-)' followed by a number is replaced by the directory that
+many positions from the bottom of the stack.
+`tt(~-0)' is the bottom of the stack.
+pindex(PUSHD_MINUS, use of)
+The tt(PUSHD_MINUS)
+option exchanges the effects of `tt(~PLUS())' and `tt(~-)' where they are
+followed by a number.
+
+cindex(directories, named)
+cindex(named directories)
+A `tt(~)' followed by anything not already covered is looked up as a
+named directory, and replaced by the value of that named directory if found.
+Named directories are typically home directories for users on the system.
+They may also be defined if the text after the `tt(~)' is the name
+of a string shell parameter whose value begins with a `tt(/)'.
+It is also possible to define directory names using the tt(-d) option to the
+tt(hash) builtin.
+
+In certain circumstances (in prompts, for instance), when the shell
+prints a path, the path is checked to see if it has a named
+directory as its prefix.  If so, then the prefix portion
+is replaced with a `tt(~)' followed by the name of the directory.
+The shortest way of referring to the directory is used,
+with ties broken in favour of using a named directory,
+except when the directory is tt(/) itself.
+
+If a word begins with an unquoted `tt(=)'
+and the tt(EQUALS) option is set,
+the remainder of the word is taken as the
+name of a command or alias.  If a command
+exists by that name, the word is replaced
+by the full pathname of the command.
+If an alias exists by that name, the word
+is replaced with the text of the alias.
+
+Filename expansion is performed on the right hand side of a parameter
+assignment, including those appearing after commands of the
+tt(typeset) family.  In this case, the right hand side will be treated
+as a colon-separated list in the manner of the tt(PATH) parameter,
+so that a `tt(~)' or an `tt(=)' following a `tt(:)' is eligible for expansion.
+All such behaviour can be
+disabled by quoting the `tt(~)', the `tt(=)', or the whole expression (but not
+simply the colon); the tt(EQUALS) option is also respected.
+
+If the option tt(MAGIC_EQUAL_SUBST) is set, any unquoted shell
+argument in the form `var(identifier)tt(=)var(expression)' becomes eligible
+for file expansion as described in the previous paragraph.  Quoting the
+first `tt(=)' also inhibits this.
+texinode(Filename Generation)()(Filename Expansion)(Expansion)
+sect(Filename Generation)
+cindex(filename generation)
+cindex(globbing)
+If a word contains an unquoted instance of one of the characters
+`tt(*)', `tt(LPAR())', `tt(|)', `tt(<)', `tt([)', or `tt(?)', it is regarded
+as a pattern for filename generation, unless the tt(GLOB) option is unset.
+pindex(GLOB, use of)
+If the tt(EXTENDED_GLOB) option is set,
+pindex(EXTENDED_GLOB, use of)
+the `tt(^)' and `tt(#)' characters also denote a pattern; otherwise
+they are not treated specially by the shell.
+
+The word is replaced with a list of sorted filenames that match
+the pattern.  If no matching pattern is found, the shell gives
+an error message, unless the tt(NULL_GLOB) option is set,
+pindex(NULL_GLOB, use of)
+in which case the word is deleted; or unless the tt(NOMATCH)
+option is unset, in which case the word is left unchanged.
+pindex(NOMATCH, use of)
+
+In filename generation,
+the character `tt(/)' must be matched explicitly;
+also, a `tt(.)' must be matched
+explicitly at the beginning of a pattern or after a `tt(/)', unless the
+tt(GLOB_DOTS) option is set.
+pindex(GLOB_DOTS, use of)
+No filename generation pattern
+matches the files `tt(.)' or `tt(..)'.  In other instances of pattern
+matching, the `tt(/)' and `tt(.)' are not treated specially.
+subsect(Glob Operators)
+startitem()
+item(tt(*))(
+Matches any string, including the null string.
+)
+item(tt(?))(
+Matches any character.
+)
+item(tt([)...tt(]))(
+Matches any of the enclosed characters.  Ranges of characters
+can be specified by separating two characters by a `tt(-)'.
+A `tt(-)' or `tt(])' may be matched by including it as the
+first character in the list.
+There are also several named classes of characters, in the form
+`tt([:)var(name)(tt:])' with the following meanings:  `tt([:alnum:])'
+alphanumeric, `tt([:alpha:])' alphabetic,
+`tt([:blank:])' space or tab,
+`tt([:cntrl:])' control character, `tt([:digit:])' decimal
+digit, `tt([:graph:])' printable character except whitespace,
+`tt([:lower:])' lowercase letter, `tt([:print:])' printable character,
+`tt([:punct:])' printable character neither alphanumeric nor whitespace,
+`tt([:space:])' whitespace character, `tt([:upper:])' uppercase letter, 
+`tt([:xdigit:])' hexadecimal digit.  These use the macros provided by
+the operating system to test for the given character combinations,
+including any modifications due to local language settings:  see
+manref(ctype)(3).  Note that the square brackets are additional
+to those enclosing the whole set of characters, so to test for a
+single alphanumeric character you need `tt([[:alnum:]])'.  Named
+character sets can be used alongside other types,
+e.g. `tt([[:alpha:]0-9])'.
+)
+xitem(tt([^)...tt(]))
+item(tt([!)...tt(]))(
+Like tt([)...tt(]), except that it matches any character which is
+not in the given set.
+)
+item(tt(<)[var(x)]tt(-)[var(y)]tt(>))(
+Matches any number in the range var(x) to var(y), inclusive.
+Either of the numbers may be omitted to make the range open-ended;
+hence `tt(<->)' matches any number.
+)
+item(tt(LPAR())...tt(RPAR()))(
+Matches the enclosed pattern.  This is used for grouping.
+If the tt(KSH_GLOB) option is set, then a
+`tt(@)', `tt(*)', `tt(+)', `tt(?)' or `tt(!)' immediately preceding
+the `tt(LPAR())' is treated specially, as detailed below.
+)
+item(var(x)tt(|)var(y))(
+Matches either var(x) or var(y).
+This operator has lower precedence than any other.
+The `tt(|)' character
+must be within parentheses, to avoid interpretation as a pipeline.
+)
+item(tt(^)var(x))(
+(Requires tt(EXTENDED_GLOB) to be set.)
+Matches anything except the pattern var(x).
+This has a higher precedence than `tt(/)', so `tt(^foo/bar)'
+will search directories in `tt(.)' except `tt(./foo)'
+for a file named `tt(bar)'.
+)
+item(var(x)tt(~)var(y))(
+(Requires tt(EXTENDED_GLOB) to be set.)
+Match anything that matches the pattern var(x) but does not match var(y).
+This has lower precedence than any operator except `tt(|)', so
+`tt(*/*~foo/bar)' will search for all files in all directories in `tt(.)'
+and then exclude `tt(foo/bar)' if there was such a match.
+It groups left-to-right, so multiple patterns can be excluded by
+`var(foo)tt(~)var(bar)tt(~)var(baz)'.
+In the exclusion pattern (var(y)), `tt(/)' and `tt(.)' are not treated
+specially the way they usually are in globbing.
+)
+item(var(x)tt(#))(
+(Requires tt(EXTENDED_GLOB) to be set.)
+Matches zero or more occurrences of the pattern var(x).
+This operator has high precedence; `tt(12#)' is equivalent to `tt(1(2#))',
+rather than `tt((12)#)'.
+)
+item(var(x)tt(##))(
+(Requires tt(EXTENDED_GLOB) to be set.)
+Matches one or more occurrences of the pattern var(x).
+This operator has high precedence; `tt(12##)' is equivalent to `tt(1(2##))',
+rather than `tt((12)##)'.
+)
+enditem()
+subsect(ksh-like Glob Operators)
+pindex(KSH_GLOB, use of)
+If the tt(KSH_GLOB) option is set, the effects of parentheses can be
+modified by a preceding `tt(@)', `tt(*)', `tt(+)', `tt(?)' or `tt(!)'.
+This character need not be unquoted to have special effects,
+but the `tt(LPAR())' must be.
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(@LPAR())...tt(RPAR()))(
+Match the pattern in the parentheses.  (Like `tt(LPAR())...tt(RPAR())'.)
+)
+item(tt(*LPAR())...tt(RPAR()))(
+Match any number of occurrences.  (Like `tt(LPAR())...tt(RPAR()#)'.)
+)
+item(tt(PLUS()LPAR())...tt(RPAR()))(
+Match at least one occurrence.  (Like `tt(LPAR())...tt(RPAR()##)'.)
+)
+item(tt(?LPAR())...tt(RPAR()))(
+Match zero or one occurrence.  (Like `tt(LPAR()|)...tt(RPAR())'.)
+)
+item(tt(!LPAR())...tt(RPAR()))(
+Match anything but the expression in parentheses.
+(Like `tt(LPAR()^LPAR())...tt(RPAR()RPAR())'.)
+)
+enditem()
+subsect(Recursive Globbing)
+A pathname component of the form `tt(LPAR())var(foo)tt(/RPAR()#)'
+matches a path consisting of zero or more directories
+matching the pattern var(foo).
+As a shorthand, `tt(**/)' is equivalent to `tt((*/)#)'.
+Thus:
+
+nofill(tt(ls (*/)#bar))
+
+or
+
+nofill(tt(ls **/bar))
+
+does a recursive directory search for files named `tt(bar)', not following
+symbolic links.  To follow links, use `tt(***/)'.
+subsect(Glob Qualifiers)
+cindex(globbing, qualifiers)
+cindex(qualifiers, globbing)
+Patterns used for filename generation may end in a
+list of qualifiers enclosed in parentheses.
+The qualifiers specify which filenames that otherwise match the given pattern
+will be inserted in the argument list.
+
+pindex(BARE_GLOB_QUAL, use of)
+If the option tt(BARE_GLOB_QUAL) is set, then a trailing set of parentheses
+containing no `tt(|)' or `tt(LPAR())' characters (or `tt(~)' if it is special)
+is taken as a set of
+glob qualifiers.  A glob subexpression that would normally be taken as glob
+qualifiers, for example `tt((^x))', can be forced to be treated as part of
+the glob pattern by doubling the parentheses, for example `tt(((^x)))'.
+
+A qualifier may be any one of the following:
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(/))(
+directories
+)
+item(tt(.))(
+plain files
+)
+item(tt(@))(
+symbolic links
+)
+item(tt(=))(
+sockets
+)
+item(tt(p))(
+named pipes (FIFOs)
+)
+item(tt(*))(
+executable plain files (0100)
+)
+item(tt(%))(
+device files (character or block special)
+)
+item(tt(%b))(
+block special files
+)
+item(tt(%c))(
+character special files
+)
+item(tt(r))(
+owner-readable files (0400)
+)
+item(tt(w))(
+owner-writable files (0200)
+)
+item(tt(x))(
+owner-executable files (0100)
+)
+item(tt(A))(
+group-readable files (0040)
+)
+item(tt(I))(
+group-writable files (0020)
+)
+item(tt(E))(
+group-executable files (0010)
+)
+item(tt(R))(
+world-readable files (0004)
+)
+item(tt(W))(
+world-writable files (0002)
+)
+item(tt(X))(
+world-executable files (0001)
+)
+item(tt(s))(
+setuid files (04000)
+)
+item(tt(S))(
+setgid files (02000)
+)
+item(tt(t))(
+files with the sticky bit (01000)
+)
+item(tt(d)var(dev))(
+files on the device var(dev)
+)
+item(tt(l)[tt(-)|tt(PLUS())]var(ct))(
+files having a link count less than var(ct) (tt(-)), greater than
+var(ct) (tt(PLUS())), or is equal to var(ct)
+)
+item(tt(U))(
+files owned by the effective user ID
+)
+item(tt(G))(
+files owned by the effective group ID
+)
+item(tt(u)var(id))(
+files owned by user ID var(id) if it is a number, if not, than the
+character after the `tt(u)' will be used as a separator and the string
+between it and the next matching separator
+(`tt(LPAR())', `tt([)', `tt({)', and `tt(<)'
+match `tt(RPAR())', `tt(])', `tt(})', and `tt(>)' respectively,
+any other character matches
+itself) will be taken as a user name, and the user ID of this user will
+be taken (e.g. `tt(u:foo:)' or `tt(u[foo])' for user `tt(foo)')
+)
+item(tt(g)var(id))(
+like tt(u)var(id) but with group IDs or names
+)
+item(tt(a)[tt(Mwhm)][tt(-)|tt(PLUS())]var(n))(
+files accessed exactly var(n) days ago.  Files accessed within the
+last var(n) days are selected using a negative value for var(n)
+(tt(-)var(n)).  Files accessed more than var(n) days ago are selected by a
+positive var(n) value (tt(PLUS())var(n)).  Optional unit specifiers `tt(M)',
+`tt(w)', `tt(h)' or `tt(m)' (e.g. `tt(ah5)') cause the check to be
+performed with months (of 30 days), weeks, hours, or minutes instead of
+days, respectively.  For instance, `tt(echo *(ah-5))' would echo files
+accessed within the last five hours.
+)
+item(tt(m)[tt(Mwhm)][tt(-)|tt(PLUS())]var(n))(
+like the file access qualifier, except that it uses the file modification
+time.
+)
+item(tt(c)[tt(Mwhm)][tt(-)|tt(PLUS())]var(n))(
+like the file access qualifier, except that it uses the file inode change
+time.
+)
+item(tt(L)[tt(PLUS())|tt(-)]var(n))(
+files less than var(n) bytes (tt(-)), more than var(n) bytes (tt(PLUS())), or
+exactly var(n) bytes in length. If this flag is directly followed by a `tt(k)'
+(`tt(K)'), `tt(m)' (`tt(M)'), or `tt(p)' (`tt(P)') (e.g. `tt(Lk-50)')
+the check is performed with kilobytes, megabytes, or blocks (of 512 bytes)
+instead.
+)
+item(tt(^))(
+negates all qualifiers following it
+)
+item(tt(-))(
+toggles between making the qualifiers work on symbolic links (the
+default) and the files they point to
+)
+item(tt(M))(
+sets the tt(MARK_DIRS) option for the current pattern
+pindex(MARK_DIRS, setting in pattern)
+)
+item(tt(T))(
+appends a trailing qualifier mark to the file names, analogous to the
+tt(LIST_TYPES) option, for the current pattern (overrides tt(M))
+)
+item(tt(N))(
+sets the tt(NULL_GLOB) option for the current pattern
+pindex(NULL_GLOB, setting in pattern)
+)
+item(tt(D))(
+sets the tt(GLOB_DOTS) option for the current pattern
+pindex(GLOB_DOTS, setting in pattern)
+)
+enditem()
+
+More than one of these lists can be combined, separated by commas. The
+whole list matches if at least one of the sublists matches (they are
+`or'ed, the qualifiers in the sublists are `and'ed).
+
+If a `tt(:)' appears in a qualifier list, the remainder of the expression in
+parenthesis is interpreted as a modifier (see noderef(Modifiers)
+in noderef(History Expansion)).  Note that
+each modifier must be introduced by a separate `tt(:)'.  Note also that the
+result after modification does not have to be an existing file.  The
+name of any existing file can be followed by a modifier of the form
+`tt((:..))' even if no actual filename generation is performed.
+Thus:
+
+nofill(tt(ls *(-/)))
+
+lists all directories and symbolic links that point to directories,
+and
+
+nofill(tt(ls *(%W)))
+
+lists all world-writable device files in the current directory, and
+
+nofill(tt(ls *(W,X)))
+
+lists all files in the current directory that are
+world-writable or world-executable, and
+
+nofill(tt(echo /tmp/foo*(u0^@:t)))
+
+outputs the basename of all root-owned files beginning with the string
+`tt(foo)' in tt(/tmp), ignoring symlinks, and
+
+nofill(tt(ls *.*~(lex|parse).[ch](^D^l1)))
+
+lists all files having a link count of one whose names contain a dot
+(but not those starting with a dot, since tt(GLOB_DOTS) is explicitly
+switched off) except for tt(lex.c), tt(lex.h), tt(parse.c) and tt(parse.h).
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/filelist.yo b/Doc/Zsh/filelist.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..298eff074
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/filelist.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,15 @@
+sect(Files)
+cindex(files used)
+startlist()
+list(tt($ZDOTDIR/.zshenv))
+list(tt($ZDOTDIR/.zprofile))
+list(tt($ZDOTDIR/.zshrc))
+list(tt($ZDOTDIR/.zlogin))
+list(tt($ZDOTDIR/.zlogout))
+list(tt(${TMPPREFIX}*)   (default is /tmp/zsh*))
+list(tt(/etc/zshenv))
+list(tt(/etc/zprofile))
+list(tt(/etc/zshrc))
+list(tt(/etc/zlogin))
+list(tt(/etc/zlogout)   (installation-specific - tt(/etc) is the default))
+endlist()
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/files.yo b/Doc/Zsh/files.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..0d775a14f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/files.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,26 @@
+texinode(Files)(Shell Grammar)(Invocation)(Top)
+chapter(Files)
+sect(Startup/Shutdown Files)
+cindex(files, startup)
+cindex(startup files)
+cindex(files, shutdown)
+cindex(shutdown files)
+pindex(NO_RCS, use of)
+Commands are first read from tt(/etc/zshenv).
+If the tt(RCS) option is unset
+within tt(/etc/zshenv), all other
+initialization files are skipped.
+Otherwise, commands are read
+from tt($ZDOTDIR/.zshenv).
+pindex(LOGIN, use of)
+If the shell is a login shell, commands
+are read from tt(/etc/zprofile) and then tt($ZDOTDIR/.zprofile).
+Then, if the shell is interactive,
+commands are read from tt(/etc/zshrc) and then tt($ZDOTDIR/.zshrc).
+Finally, if the shell is a login shell, tt(/etc/zlogin) and
+tt($ZDOTDIR/.zlogin) are read.
+
+If tt(ZDOTDIR) is unset, tt(HOME) is used instead.
+Those files listed above as being in tt(/etc) may be in another
+directory, depending on the installation.
+ifnzman(includefile(Zsh/filelist.yo))
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/func.yo b/Doc/Zsh/func.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..c2fc71d55
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/func.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,107 @@
+texinode(Functions)(Jobs & Signals)(Command Execution)(Top)
+chapter(Functions)
+ifzman(\
+sect(Functions)
+)\
+cindex(functions)
+findex(function)
+The tt(function) reserved word is used to define shell functions.
+Shell functions are read in and stored internally.
+Alias names are resolved when the function is read.
+Functions are executed like commands with the arguments
+passed as positional parameters.
+(See noderef(Command Execution).)
+
+Functions execute in the same process as the caller and
+share all files
+and present working directory with the
+caller.  A trap on tt(EXIT) set inside a function
+is executed after the function completes in the environment
+of the caller.
+
+findex(return, use of)
+The tt(return) builtin is used to return from function calls.
+
+findex(functions, use of)
+Function identifiers can be listed with the tt(functions) builtin.
+findex(unfunction, use of)
+Functions can be undefined with the tt(unfunction) builtin.
+sect(Autoloading Functions)
+findex(autoload, use of)
+cindex(autoloading functions)
+cindex(functions, autoloading)
+A function can be marked as em(undefined) using the tt(autoload) builtin
+(or `tt(functions -u)' or `tt(typeset -fu)').  Such a function has no
+body.  When the function is first executed, the tt(fpath)
+variable will be searched for a file with the same name as the
+function.
+
+pindex(KSH_AUTOLOAD, use of)
+If the tt(KSH_AUTOLOAD) option is set, or the file contains only a simple
+definition of the function, the file's contents will be
+executed.  It would normally define the function in question, but may
+also perform initialisation.
+It is executed in the context of the function
+execution, and may therefore define local parameters.
+
+Otherwise, the function is defined such that its body is the
+complete contents of the file.  This form allows the file to be
+used directly as an executable shell script.
+Initialisation code can be executed, but only as part of the first
+function execution, so the function would have to redefine itself to
+avoid reinitialising on the next execution.
+
+If this processing of the file results in the function being
+fully defined, the function itself is then executed.
+sect(Special Functions)
+The following functions, if defined, have special meaning to
+the shell:
+
+startitem()
+findex(chpwd)
+item(tt(chpwd))(
+Executed whenever the current working directory is changed.
+)
+findex(periodic)
+item(tt(periodic))(
+vindex(PERIOD)
+If the parameter tt(PERIOD)
+is set, this function is executed every tt($PERIOD)
+seconds, just before a prompt.
+)
+findex(precmd)
+item(tt(precmd))(
+Executed before each prompt.
+)
+findex(preexec)
+item(tt(preexec))(
+Executed just after a command has been read and is about to be
+executed.  If the history mechanism is active, the string to be
+executed is passed as an argument.
+)
+item(tt(TRAP)var(NAL))(
+cindex(signals, trapping)
+cindex(trapping signals)
+If defined and non-null,
+this function will be executed whenever the shell
+catches a signal tt(SIG)var(NAL), where var(NAL) is a signal
+name as specified for the tt(kill) builtin.
+The signal number will be passed as the first parameter to the function.
+
+If a function of this form is defined and null,
+the shell and processes spawned by it will ignore tt(SIG)var(NAL).
+)
+findex(TRAPDEBUG)
+item(tt(TRAPDEBUG))(
+Executed after each command.
+)
+findex(TRAPEXIT)
+item(tt(TRAPEXIT))(
+Executed when the shell exits,
+or when the current function exits if defined inside a function.
+)
+findex(TRAPZERR)
+item(tt(TRAPZERR))(
+Executed whenever a command has a non-zero exit status.
+)
+enditem()
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/grammar.yo b/Doc/Zsh/grammar.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..c78aed4b4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/grammar.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,335 @@
+texinode(Shell Grammar)(Redirection)(Files)(Top)
+chapter(Shell Grammar)
+cindex(shell grammar)
+cindex(grammar, shell)
+startmenu()
+menu(Simple Commands & Pipelines)
+menu(Precommand Modifiers)
+menu(Complex Commands)
+menu(Alternate Forms For Complex Commands)
+menu(Reserved Words)
+menu(Comments)
+menu(Aliasing)
+menu(Quoting)
+endmenu()
+texinode(Simple Commands & Pipelines)(Precommand Modifiers)()(Shell Grammar)
+sect(Simple Commands & Pipelines)
+cindex(simple commands)
+cindex(commands, simple)
+A em(simple command) is a sequence of optional parameter
+assignments followed by blank-separated words,
+with optional redirections interspersed.
+The first word is the command to be executed, and the remaining
+words, if any, are arguments to the command.
+If a command name is given, the parameter assignments modify
+the environment of the command when it is executed.
+The value of a simple command is its exit status,
+or 128 plus the signal number if terminated by a signal.
+
+cindex(pipeline)
+A em(pipeline) is either a simple command, or a sequence of two or more
+simple commands where each command is separated from the next by `tt(|)'
+or `tt(|&)'.  Where commands are separated by `tt(|)', the standard
+output of the first command is connected to the
+standard input of the next.  `tt(|&)' is shorthand for `tt(2>&1 |)', which
+connects both the standard output and the standard error of the
+command to the standard input of the next.  The value of a pipeline
+is the value of the last command, unless the pipeline is preceded by
+`tt(!)' in which case the value is the logical inverse of the value of the
+last command.
+
+findex(coproc)
+cindex(coprocess)
+If a pipeline is preceded by `tt(coproc)', it is executed as a coprocess;
+a two-way pipe is established between it and the parent shell.  The
+shell can read from or write to the coprocess by means of the `tt(>&p)'
+and `tt(<&p)' redirection operators or with `tt(print -p)' and `tt(read -p)'.
+A pipeline cannot be preceded by both `tt(coproc)' and `tt(!)'.
+
+cindex(sublist)
+A em(sublist) is either a single pipeline, or a sequence of two or more
+pipelines separated by `tt(&&)' or `tt(||)'.  If two pipelines are separated
+by `tt(&&)', the second pipeline is executed only if the first succeeds
+(returns a zero value).  If two pipelines are separated by `tt(||)', the
+second is executed only if the first fails (returns a nonzero value).
+Both operators have equal precedence and are left associative.
+The value of the sublist is the value of the last pipeline executed.
+
+cindex(list)
+A em(list) is a sequence of zero or more sublists, in which each sublist
+is terminated by `tt(;)', `tt(&)', `tt(&|)', `tt(&!)', or a newline.
+This terminator
+may optionally be omitted from the last sublist in the list when the
+list appears as a complex command inside `tt(LPAR())...tt(RPAR())'
+or `tt({)...tt(})'.  When a
+sublist is terminated by `tt(;)' or newline, the shell waits for it to
+finish before executing the next sublist.  If a sublist is terminated
+by a `tt(&)', `tt(&|)', or `tt(&!)',
+the shell executes it in the background, and
+does not wait for it to finish.
+A backgrounded sublist returns a status of zero.
+texinode(Precommand Modifiers)(Complex Commands)(Simple Commands & Pipelines)(Shell Grammar)
+sect(Precommand Modifiers)
+cindex(precommand modifiers)
+cindex(modifiers, precommand)
+A simple command may be preceded by a em(precommand modifier),
+which will alter how the command is interpreted.  These modifiers are
+shell builtin commands with the exception of tt(nocorrect) which is
+a reserved word.
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(-))(
+The command is executed with a `tt(-)' prepended to its
+tt(argv[0]) string.
+)
+item(tt(noglob))(
+Filename generation (globbing) is not performed on any of
+the words.
+)
+item(tt(nocorrect))(
+Spelling correction is not done on any of the words.
+)
+item(tt(exec))(
+The command is executed in the parent shell without forking.
+)
+item(tt(command))(
+The command word is taken to be the name of an external command,
+rather than a shell function or builtin.
+)
+item(tt(builtin))(
+The command word is taken to be the name of a builtin command,
+rather than a shell function or external command.
+)
+enditem()
+texinode(Complex Commands)(Alternate Forms For Complex Commands)(Precommand Modifiers)(Shell Grammar)
+sect(Complex Commands)
+cindex(complex commands)
+cindex(commands, complex)
+A em(complex command) in zsh is one of the following:
+
+startitem()
+findex(if)
+cindex(if construct)
+item(tt(if) var(list) tt(then) var(list) [ tt(elif) var(list) tt(then) var(list) ] ... [ tt(else) var(list) ] tt(fi))(
+The tt(if) var(list) is executed, and if it returns a zero exit status,
+the tt(then) var(list) is executed.
+Otherwise, the tt(elif) var(list) is executed and if its value is zero,
+the tt(then) var(list) is executed.
+If each tt(elif) var(list) returns nonzero, the tt(else) var(list) is executed.
+)
+findex(for)
+cindex(for loops)
+cindex(loops, for)
+item(tt(for) var(name) [ tt(in) var(word) ... var(term) ] tt(do) var(list) tt(done))(
+where var(term) is at least one newline or tt(;).
+Expand the list of var(word)s, and set the parameter
+var(name) to each of them in turn, executing
+var(list) each time.  If the tt(in) var(word) is omitted,
+use the positional parameters instead of the var(word)s.
+)
+item(tt(for LPAR()LPAR()) [var(expr1)] tt(;) [var(expr2)] tt(;) [var(expr3)] tt(RPAR()RPAR() do) var(list) tt(done))(
+The arithmetic expression var(expr1) is evaluated first (see
+noderef(Arithmetic Evaluation)).  The arithmetic expression
+var(expr2) is repeatedly evaluated until it evaluates to zero and
+when non-zero, var(list) is executed and the arithmetic expression
+var(expr3) evaluated.  If any expression is omitted, then it behaves
+as if it evaluated to 1.
+)
+findex(while)
+cindex(while loops)
+cindex(loops, while)
+item(tt(while) var(list) tt(do) var(list) tt(done))(
+Execute the tt(do) var(list) as long as the tt(while) var(list)
+returns a zero exit status.
+)
+findex(until)
+cindex(until loops)
+cindex(loops, until)
+item(tt(until) var(list) tt(do) var(list) tt(done))(
+Execute the tt(do) var(list) as long as tt(until) var(list)
+returns a nonzero exit status.
+)
+findex(repeat)
+cindex(repeat loops)
+cindex(loops, repeat)
+item(tt(repeat) var(word) tt(do) var(list) tt(done))(
+var(word) is expanded and treated as an arithmetic expression,
+which must evaluate to a number var(n).
+var(list) is then executed var(n) times.
+)
+findex(case)
+cindex(case selection)
+cindex(selection, case)
+item(tt(case) var(word) tt(in) [ [tt(LPAR())] var(pattern) [ tt(|) var(pattern) ] ... tt(RPAR()) var(list) (tt(;;)|tt(;&)) ] ... tt(esac))(
+Execute the var(list) associated with the first var(pattern)
+that matches var(word), if any.  The form of the patterns
+is the same as that used for filename generation.  See
+noderef(Filename Generation).
+If the var(list) that is executed is terminated with tt(;&) rather than
+tt(;;), the following list is also executed.  This continues until either
+a list is terminated with tt(;;) or the tt(esac) is reached.
+)
+findex(select)
+cindex(user selection)
+cindex(selection, user)
+item(tt(select) var(name) [ tt(in) var(word) ... var(term) ] tt(do) var(list) tt(done))(
+where var(term) is one ore more newline or tt(;).
+Print the set of var(word)s, each preceded by a number.
+If the tt(in) var(word) is omitted, use the positional parameters.
+The tt(PROMPT3) prompt is printed and a line is read from standard
+input.  If this line consists of the number of one of the listed
+var(word)s, then the parameter var(name)
+is set to the var(word) corresponding to this number.
+If this line is empty, the selection list is printed again.
+Otherwise, the value of the parameter var(name) is set to null.
+The contents of the line read from standard input is saved
+in the parameter tt(REPLY).  var(list) is executed
+for each selection until a break or end-of-file is encountered.
+)
+cindex(subshells)
+item(tt(LPAR()) var(list) tt(RPAR()))(
+Execute var(list) in a subshell.  Traps set by the tt(trap) builtin
+are reset to their default values while executing var(list).
+)
+item(tt({) var(list) tt(}))(
+Execute var(list).
+)
+xitem(tt(function) var(word) ... [ tt(()) ] [ var(term) ] tt({) var(list) tt(}))
+xitem(var(word) ... tt(()) [ var(term) ] tt({) var(list) tt(}))
+item(var(word) ... tt(()) [ var(term) ] var(command))(
+where var(term) is one or more newline or tt(;).
+Define a function which is referenced by any one of var(word).
+Normally, only one var(word) is provided; multiple var(word)s
+are usually only useful for setting traps.
+The body of the function is the var(list) between
+the tt({) and tt(}).  See noderef(Functions).
+)
+cindex(timing)
+item(tt(time) [ var(pipeline) ])(
+The var(pipeline) is executed, and timing statistics are
+reported on the standard error in the form specified
+by the tt(TIMEFMT) parameter.
+If var(pipeline) is omitted, print statistics about the
+shell process and its children.
+)
+cindex(testing conditional expression)
+item(tt([[) var(exp) tt(]]))(
+Evaluates the conditional expression var(exp)
+and return a zero exit status if it is true.
+See noderef(Conditional Expressions)
+for a description of var(exp).
+)
+enditem()
+texinode(Alternate Forms For Complex Commands)(Reserved Words)(Complex Commands)(Shell Grammar)
+sect(Alternate Forms For Complex Commands)
+cindex(alternate forms for complex commands)
+cindex(commands, alternate forms for complex)
+Many of zsh's complex commands have alternate forms.  These particular
+versions of complex commands should be considered deprecated and may be
+removed in the future.  The versions in the previous section should be
+preferred instead.  The short versions below only work if var(sublist)
+is of the form `tt({) var(list) tt(})' or if the tt(SHORT_LOOPS)
+option is set.
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(if) var(list) tt({) var(list) tt(}) [ tt(elif) var(list) tt({) var(list) tt(}) ] ... [ tt(else {) var(list) tt(}) ])(
+An alternate form of tt(if).
+)
+item(tt(if) var(list) var(sublist))(
+A short form of the alternate `if'.
+)
+item(tt(for) var(name) tt(LPAR()) var(word) ... tt(RPAR()) var(sublist))(
+A short form of tt(for).
+)
+item(tt(for) var(name) [ tt(in) var(word) ... var(term) ] var(sublist))(
+where var(term) is at least one newline or tt(;).
+Another short form of tt(for).
+)
+item(tt(for LPAR()LPAR()) [var(expr1)] tt(;) [var(expr2)] tt(;) [var(expr3)] tt(RPAR()RPAR()) var(sublist))(
+A short form of the arithmetic tt(for) command.
+)
+item(tt(foreach) var(name) tt(LPAR()) var(word) ... tt(RPAR()) var(list) tt(end))(
+Another form of tt(for).
+)
+item(tt(while) var(list) tt({) var(list) tt(}))(
+An alternative form of tt(while).
+)
+item(tt(until) var(list) tt({) var(list) tt(}))(
+An alternative form of tt(until).
+)
+item(tt(repeat) var(word) var(sublist))(
+This is a short form of tt(repeat).
+)
+item(tt(case) var(word) tt({) [ [tt(LPAR())] var(pattern) [ tt(|) var(pattern) ] ... tt(RPAR()) var(list) (tt(;;)|tt(;&)) ] ... tt(}))(
+An alternative form of tt(case).
+)
+item(tt(select) var(name) [ tt(in) var(word) var(term) ] var(sublist))(
+where var(term) is at least one newline or tt(;).
+A short form of tt(select).
+)
+enditem()
+texinode(Reserved Words)(Comments)(Alternate Forms For Complex Commands)(Shell Grammar)
+sect(Reserved Words)
+cindex(reserved words)
+findex(disable, use of)
+The following words are recognized as reserved words when used as the first
+word of a command unless quoted or disabled using tt(disable -r):
+
+tt(do done esac then elif else fi for case
+if while function repeat time until
+select coproc nocorrect foreach end ! [[ { })
+
+Additionally, `tt(})' is recognized in any position if the tt(IGNORE_BRACES) option
+is not set.
+texinode(Comments)(Aliasing)(Reserved Words)(Shell Grammar)
+sect(Comments)
+cindex(comments)
+pindex(INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS, use of)
+vindex(histchars, use of)
+In noninteractive shells, or in interactive shells with the
+tt(INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS) option set, a word beginning
+with the third character of the tt(histchars) parameter
+(`tt(#)' by default) causes that word and all the following
+characters up to a newline to be ignored.
+texinode(Aliasing)(Quoting)(Comments)(Shell Grammar)
+sect(Aliasing)
+cindex(aliasing)
+Every token in the shell input is checked to see if there
+is an alias defined for it.
+If so, it is replaced by the text of the alias if it is in command
+position (if it could be the first word of a simple command),
+or if the alias is global.
+If the text ends with a space, the next word in the shell input
+is treated as though it were in command position for purposes of alias
+expansion.
+findex(alias, use of)
+cindex(aliases, global)
+An alias is defined using the tt(alias) builtin; global aliases
+may be defined using the tt(-g) option to that builtin.
+
+Alias substitution is done on the shell input before any
+other substitution except history substitution.  Therefore,
+if an alias is defined for the word tt(foo), alias substitution
+may be avoided by quoting part of the word, e.g. tt(\foo).
+But there is nothing to prevent an alias being defined
+for tt(\foo) as well.
+texinode(Quoting)()(Aliasing)(Shell Grammar)
+sect(Quoting)
+cindex(quoting)
+A character may be var(quoted) (that is, made
+to stand for itself) by preceding it with a `tt(\)'.
+`tt(\)' followed by a newline is ignored.
+
+A string enclosed between `tt($')' and `tt(')' is
+processed the same way as the string arguments of the
+tt(print) builtin, and the resulting string is considered to be
+entirely quoted.  A literal `tt(')' character can be included in the
+string by using the `tt(\')' escape.
+
+All characters enclosed between a pair of single quotes (tt('')) that
+is not preceded by a `tt($)' are quoted.  A single quote cannot appear
+within single quotes.
+
+Inside double quotes (tt("")), parameter and
+command substitution occurs, and `tt(\)' quotes the characters
+`tt(\)', `tt(`)', `tt(")', and `tt($)'.
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/guide.yo b/Doc/Zsh/guide.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..d38a0d308
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/guide.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,149 @@
+texiifinfo(\
+texinode(Top)(The Z Shell Guide)((dir))((dir))
+texitop(The Z Shell Guide)
+This Info file documents Zsh, a freely available UNIX command interpreter
+(shell), which of the standard shells most closely resembles the Korn shell
+(ksh), although it is not completely compatible.
+
+Version version(), last updated date().
+)\
+
+startmenu()
+menu(The Z Shell Guide)
+menu(Introduction)
+menu(Invocation)
+menu(Files)
+menu(Shell Grammar)
+menu(Redirection)
+menu(Command Execution)
+menu(Functions)
+menu(Jobs & Signals)
+menu(Arithmetic Evaluation)
+menu(Conditional Expressions)
+menu(Compatibility)
+menu(Prompt Expansion)
+menu(Restricted Shell)
+menu(Expansion)
+menu(Parameters)
+menu(Options)
+menu(Shell Builtin Commands)
+menu(Zsh Line Editor)
+menu(Programmable Completion)
+menu(Zsh Modules)
+
+ --- Indices ---
+
+menu(Concept Index)
+menu(Variables Index)
+menu(Options Index)
+menu(Functions Index)
+menu(Editor Functions Index)
+menu(Keystroke Index)
+
+ --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
+
+Introduction
+
+menu(Author)
+menu(Availability)
+menu(Mailing Lists)
+menu(The Zsh FAQ)
+menu(The Zsh Web Page)
+menu(See Also)
+
+Shell Grammar
+
+menu(Simple Commands & Pipelines)
+menu(Precommand Modifiers)
+menu(Complex Commands)
+menu(Alternate Forms For Complex Commands)
+menu(Reserved Words)
+menu(Comments)
+menu(Aliasing)
+menu(Quoting)
+
+Expansion
+
+menu(History Expansion)
+menu(Process Substitution)
+menu(Parameter Expansion)
+menu(Command Substitution)
+menu(Arithmetic Expansion)
+menu(Brace Expansion)
+menu(Filename Expansion)
+menu(Filename Generation)
+
+Parameters
+
+menu(Local Parameters)
+menu(Array Parameters)
+menu(Positional Parameters)
+menu(Parameters Set By The Shell)
+menu(Parameters Used By The Shell)
+
+Options
+
+menu(Description of Options)
+menu(Single Letter Options)
+
+Zsh Line Editor
+
+menu(Movement)
+menu(History Control)
+menu(Modifying Text)
+menu(Arguments)
+menu(Completion)
+menu(Miscellaneous)
+
+Programmable Completion
+
+menu(Command Flags)
+menu(Option Flags)
+menu(Alternative Completion)
+menu(Extended Completion)
+menu(Example)
+
+Zsh Modules
+
+menu(The cap Module)
+menu(The clone Module)
+menu(The comp1 Module)
+menu(The compctl Module)
+menu(The deltochar Module)
+menu(The example Module)
+menu(The files Module)
+menu(The sched Module)
+menu(The stat Module)
+menu(The zle Module)
+endmenu()
+texinode(The Z Shell Guide)(Introduction)(Top)(Top)
+chapter(The Z Shell Guide)
+This document has been produced from the texinfo file tt(zsh.texi),
+included in the tt(Doc) sub-directory of the Zsh distribution.
+sect(Producing documentation from zsh.texi)
+The texinfo source may be converted into several formats:
+
+startitem()
+item(The Info guide)(
+The Info format allows searching for topics, commands, functions, etc.
+from the many Indices. The command `tt(makeinfo zsh.texi)' is used to
+produce the Info documentation.
+)
+item(The printed guide)(
+The command `tt(texi2dvi zsh.texi)' will output tt(zsh.dvi) which can
+then be processed with bf(dvips) and optionally bf(gs) (Ghostscript) to
+produce a nicely formatted printed guide.
+)
+item(The HTML guide)(
+Mark Borges, tt(<mdb@cdc.noaa.gov), maintains an HTML version of this
+guide at tt(http://www.peak.org/zsh/Doc/zsh_toc.html).
+(The HTML version is produced with bf(texi2html), which may be obtained
+from tt(http://wwwcn.cern.ch/dci/texi2html/). The command is
+`tt(texi2html -split_chapter -expandinfo zsh.texi)'.)
+)
+enditem()
+
+For those who do not have the necessary tools to process texinfo,
+precompiled documentation (PostScript, dvi, info and HTML formats)
+is available from the zsh archive site or its mirrors, in the file
+tt(zsh-doc.tar.gz). (See noderef(Availability) for a list of sites.)
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/index.yo b/Doc/Zsh/index.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..7afa14d07
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/index.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,24 @@
+ifztexi(\
+def(printindex)(2)(\
+  NOTRANS(@unnumbered) ARG1NL()\
+  NL()\
+  NOTRANS(@printindex) ARG2\
+)\
+texinode(Concept Index)(Variables Index)(Top)(Top)
+printindex(Concept Index)(cp)
+
+texinode(Variables Index)(Options Index)(Concept Index)(Top)
+printindex(Variables Index)(vr)
+
+texinode(Options Index)(Functions Index)(Variables Index)(Top)
+printindex(Options Index)(pg)
+
+texinode(Functions Index)(Editor Functions Index)(Options Index)(Top)
+printindex(Functions Index)(fn)
+
+texinode(Editor Functions Index)(Keystroke Index)(Functions Index)(Top)
+printindex(Editor Functions Index)(tp)
+
+texinode(Keystroke Index)()(Editor Functions Index)(Top)
+printindex(Keystroke Index)(ky)
+)\
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/intro.yo b/Doc/Zsh/intro.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..ebb678f70
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/intro.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,38 @@
+texinode(Introduction)(Invocation)(The Z Shell Guide)(Top)
+chapter(Introduction)
+ifzman(\
+sect(Synopsis)
+Because zsh contains many features, the zsh manual has been split into
+a number of section+CHAR(s)\
+ifzshall(\
+.  This manual page includes all the separate manual pages in the
+following order\
+)\
+:
+
+startlist()
+ifzshone(\
+list(em(zsh)          Zsh overview (this section))
+)\
+list(em(zshmisc)      Anything not fitting into the other sections)
+list(em(zshexpn)      Zsh command and parameter expansion)
+list(em(zshparam)     Zsh parameters)
+list(em(zshoptions)   Zsh options)
+list(em(zshbuiltins)  Zsh built-in functions)
+list(em(zshzle)       Zsh command line editing)
+list(em(zshcompctl)   Zsh completion control)
+list(em(zshmodules)   Zsh loadable modules)
+ifzshone(\
+list(em(zshall)       Meta-man page containing all of the above)
+)\
+endlist()
+sect(Description)
+)\
+Zsh is a UNIX command interpreter (shell) usable as an interactive
+login shell and as a shell script command processor.  Of the standard shells,
+zsh most closely resembles bf(ksh) but includes many enhancements.  Zsh
+has command line editing, builtin spelling correction, programmable
+command completion, shell functions (with autoloading), a history
+mechanism, and a host of other features.
+includefile(Zsh/metafaq.yo)
+ifnzman(includefile(Zsh/seealso.yo))
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/invoke.yo b/Doc/Zsh/invoke.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..40a5513d0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/invoke.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,23 @@
+texinode(Invocation)(Files)(Introduction)(Top)
+chapter(Invocation)
+cindex(invocation)
+sect(Invocation Options)
+cindex(flags, shell)
+cindex(shell flags)
+If the tt(-s) flag is not present and an argument is given,
+the first argument is taken to be the pathname of a script to
+execute.  The remaining arguments are assigned to the positional
+parameters.  The following flags are interpreted by the shell
+when invoked:
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(-c) var(string))(
+Read commands from var(string).
+)
+item(tt(-i))(
+Force shell to be interactive.
+)
+item(tt(-s))(
+Read command from the standard input.
+)
+enditem()
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/jobs.yo b/Doc/Zsh/jobs.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..752181f02
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/jobs.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,91 @@
+texinode(Jobs & Signals)(Arithmetic Evaluation)(Functions)(Top)
+chapter(Jobs & Signals)
+sect(Jobs)
+cindex(jobs)
+If the tt(MONITOR) option is set,
+an interactive shell associates a em(job) with each pipeline.
+It keeps a table of current jobs, printed by the tt(jobs)
+command, and assigns them small integer numbers.
+When a job is started asynchronously with `tt(&)',
+the shell prints a line which looks like:
+
+nofill(tt([1] 1234))
+
+indicating that the job which was started asynchronously was job number
+1 and had one (top-level) process, whose process ID was 1234.
+
+If a job is started with `tt(&|)' or `tt(&!)',
+then that job is immediately disowned.  After startup, it
+does not have a place in the job table, and is not subject
+to the job control features described here.
+
+If you are running a job and wish to do something else you may hit the key
+^Z (control-Z) which sends a tt(TSTP) signal to the current job.
+cindex(jobs, suspending)
+cindex(suspending jobs)
+The shell will then normally indicate that the job has been `suspended',
+and print another prompt.  You can then manipulate the state of this job,
+findex(bg, use of)
+putting it in the background with the tt(bg) command, or run some other
+commands and then eventually bring the job back into the foreground with
+findex(fg, use of)
+the foreground command tt(fg).  A ^Z takes effect immediately and
+is like an interrupt in that pending output and unread input are discarded
+when it is typed.
+
+A job being run in the background will suspend if it tries to read
+from the terminal.
+cindex(background jobs, I/O)
+cindex(jobs, background, I/O)
+Background jobs are normally allowed to produce output,
+but this can be disabled by giving the command `tt(stty tostop)'.
+If you set this
+tty option, then background jobs will suspend when they try to produce
+output like they do when they try to read input.
+
+cindex(jobs, referring to)
+cindex(referring to jobs)
+There are several ways to refer to jobs in the shell.
+A job can be referred to by the process ID of any process of the job
+or by one of the following:
+
+startsitem()
+sitem(tt(%)var(number))(The job with the given number.)
+sitem(tt(%)var(string))(Any job whose command line begins with var(string).)
+sitem(tt(%?)var(string))(Any job whose command line contains var(string).)
+sitem(tt(%%))(Current job.)
+sitem(tt(%PLUS()))(Equivalent to `tt(%%)'.)
+sitem(tt(%-))(Previous job.)
+endsitem()
+
+The shell learns immediately whenever a process changes state.
+pindex(NOTIFY, use of)
+It normally informs you whenever a job becomes blocked so that
+no further progress is possible.  If the tt(NOTIFY) option is not set,
+it waits until just before it prints a prompt before it informs you.
+
+When the monitor mode is on, each background job that completes
+triggers any trap set for tt(CHLD).
+
+When you try to leave the shell while jobs are running or suspended, you will
+be warned that `You have suspended (running) jobs'.
+You may use the tt(jobs) command to see what they are.
+If you do this or immediately try to
+exit again, the shell will not warn you a second time; the suspended
+jobs will be terminated, and the running jobs will be sent
+a tt(SIGHUP) signal, if the tt(HUP) option is set.
+pindex(HUP, use of)
+
+cindex(jobs, disowning)
+cindex(disowning jobs)
+findex(disown, use of)
+To avoid having the shell terminate the running jobs, either
+use the bf(nohup) command (see manref(nohup)(1))
+or the tt(disown) builtin.
+sect(Signals)
+The tt(INT) and tt(QUIT) signals for an invoked
+command are ignored if the command is followed by
+`tt(&)' and the tt(MONITOR) option is not active.
+Otherwise, signals have the values
+inherited by the shell from its parent
+(but see the tt(TRAP)var(NAL) special functions in noderef(Functions)).
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/metafaq.yo b/Doc/Zsh/metafaq.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..a9e0bbecf
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/metafaq.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,142 @@
+startmenu()
+menu(Author)
+menu(Availability)
+menu(Mailing Lists)
+menu(The Zsh FAQ)
+menu(The Zsh Web Page)
+menu(See Also)
+endmenu()
+texinode(Author)(Availability)()(Introduction)
+sect(Author)
+cindex(author)
+Zsh was originally written by Paul Falstad tt(<pf@zsh.org>).
+Zsh is now maintained by the members of the zsh-workers mailing
+list tt(<zsh-workers@math.gatech.edu>).  The development is currently
+coordinated by Andrew Main (Zefram) tt(<zefram@zsh.org>).  The coordinator
+can be contacted at tt(<coordinator@zsh.org>), but matters relating to
+the code should generally go to the mailing list.
+texinode(Availability)(Mailing Lists)(Author)(Introduction)
+sect(Availability)
+Zsh is available from the following anonymous FTP sites.  These mirror
+sites are kept frequently up to date.  The sites marked with em((G))
+may be mirroring tt(ftp.math.gatech.edu) instead of the primary site.
+The sites marked with em((H)) may be mirroring tt(ftp.cs.elte.hu)
+instead of the primary site.
+
+startitem()
+item(Primary site)(
+nofill(tt(ftp://ftp.zsh.org/pub/zsh/)
+tt(http://www.zsh.org/pub/zsh/))
+)
+item(Australia)(
+nofill(tt(ftp://ftp.zsh.org/pub/zsh/)
+tt(http://www.zsh.org/pub/zsh/)
+tt(ftp://ftp.ips.oz.au/pub/packages/zsh/)  em((G))  em((H)))
+)
+item(Denmark)(
+nofill(tt(ftp://sunsite.auc.dk/pub/unix/shells/zsh/))
+)
+item(Finland)(
+nofill(tt(ftp://ftp.funet.fi/pub/unix/shells/zsh/)  em((H)))
+)
+item(France)(
+nofill(tt(ftp://ftp.cenatls.cena.dgac.fr/pub/shells/zsh/))
+)
+item(Germany)(
+nofill(tt(ftp://ftp.fu-berlin.de/pub/unix/shells/zsh/)  em((H))
+tt(ftp://ftp.gmd.de/packages/zsh/)  em((H))
+tt(ftp://ftp.uni-trier.de/pub/unix/shell/zsh/)  em((H)))
+)
+item(Hungary)(
+nofill(tt(ftp://ftp.cs.elte.hu/pub/zsh/)
+tt(http://www.cs.elte.hu/pub/zsh/)
+tt(ftp://ftp.kfki.hu/pub/packages/zsh/)  em((H)))
+)
+item(Israel)(
+nofill(tt(ftp://ftp.math.technion.ac.il/mirror/ftp.zsh.org/pub/zsh/)
+tt(http://www.math.technion.ac.il/mirror/ftp.zsh.org/pub/zsh/))
+)
+item(Japan)(
+nofill(tt(ftp://ftp.tohoku.ac.jp/mirror/zsh/)  em((H))
+tt(ftp://ftp.nis.co.jp/pub/shells/zsh/)  em((H)))
+)
+item(Norway)(
+nofill(tt(ftp://ftp.uit.no/pub/unix/shells/zsh/)  em((H)))
+)
+item(Romania)(
+nofill(tt(ftp://ftp.roedu.net/pub/mirrors/ftp.zsh.org/pub/zsh/))
+)
+item(Slovenia)(
+nofill(tt(ftp://ftp.siol.net/pub/unix/shells/zsh/)  em((H)))
+)
+item(Sweden)(
+nofill(tt(ftp://ftp.lysator.liu.se/pub/unix/zsh/)  em((H)))
+)
+item(UK)(
+nofill(tt(ftp://ftp.net.lut.ac.uk/zsh/)  em((H))
+tt(ftp://sunsite.doc.ic.ac.uk/packages/unix/shells/zsh/)  em((G)))
+)
+item(USA)(
+nofill(tt(ftp://ftp.math.gatech.edu/pub/zsh/)
+tt(ftp://uiarchive.uiuc.edu/pub/packages/shells/zsh/)
+tt(ftp://ftp.sterling.com/zsh/)  em((G))  em((H))
+tt(ftp://ftp.rge.com/pub/shells/zsh/)  em((G))  em((H))
+tt(ftp://foad.org/pub/zsh/)
+tt(http://foad.org/zsh/))
+)
+enditem()
+texinode(Mailing Lists)(The Zsh FAQ)(Availability)(Introduction)
+sect(Mailing Lists)
+cindex(mailing lists)
+Zsh has 3 mailing lists:
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(<zsh-announce@math.gatech.edu>))(
+Announcements about releases, major changes in the shell and the
+monthly posting of the Zsh FAQ.  (moderated)
+)
+item(tt(<zsh-users@math.gatech.edu>))(
+User discussions.
+)
+item(tt(<zsh-workers@math.gatech.edu>))(
+Hacking, development, bug reports and patches.
+)
+enditem()
+
+To subscribe, send mail with the SUBJECT `tt(subscribe) var(<e-mail-address>)'
+to the associated administrative address for the mailing list.
+
+startlist()
+list(tt(<zsh-announce-request@math.gatech.edu>))
+list(tt(<zsh-users-request@math.gatech.edu>))
+list(tt(<zsh-workers-request@math.gatech.edu>))
+endlist()
+
+Unsubscribing is done similarly.
+
+YOU ONLY NEED TO JOIN ONE OF THE MAILING LISTS AS THEY ARE NESTED.
+All submissions to bf(zsh-announce) are automatically forwarded to
+bf(zsh-users).  All submissions to bf(zsh-users) are automatically
+forwarded to bf(zsh-workers).
+
+If you have problems subscribing/unsubscribing to any of the mailing
+lists, send mail to tt(<listmaster@zsh.org>).  The mailing lists are
+maintained by Richard Coleman tt(<coleman@zsh.org>).
+
+The mailing lists are archived; the archives can be accessed via the
+administrative addresses listed above.  There is also a hypertext
+archive, maintained by Geoff Wing tt(<gcw@zsh.org>), available at
+tt(http://www.zsh.org/mla/).
+texinode(The Zsh FAQ)(The Zsh Web Page)(Mailing Lists)(Introduction)
+sect(The Zsh FAQ)
+Zsh has a list of Frequently Asked Questions (FAQ), maintained by
+Peter Stephenson tt(<pws@zsh.org>).  It is regularly posted to the
+newsgroup bf(comp.unix.shell) and the bf(zsh-announce) mailing list.
+The latest version can be found at any of the Zsh FTP sites, or at
+tt(http://www.zsh.org/FAQ/).  The contact address for FAQ-related matters
+is tt(<faqmaster@zsh.org>).
+texinode(The Zsh Web Page)(See Also)(The Zsh FAQ)(Introduction)
+sect(The Zsh Web Page)
+Zsh has a web page which is located at tt(http://www.zsh.org/).  This is
+maintained by Karsten Thygesen tt(<karthy@zsh.org>), of SunSITE Denmark.
+The contact address for web-related matters is tt(<webmaster@zsh.org>).
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/mod_cap.yo b/Doc/Zsh/mod_cap.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..f6513b314
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/mod_cap.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,28 @@
+texinode(The cap Module)(The clone Module)()(Zsh Modules)
+sect(The cap Module)
+The tt(cap) module is used for manipulating POSIX.1e (POSIX.6) capability
+sets.  If the operating system does not support this interface, the
+builtins defined by this module will do nothing.
+The builtins in this module are:
+
+startitem()
+findex(cap)
+cindex(capabilities, setting)
+item(tt(cap) [ var(capabilities) ])(
+Change the shell's process capability sets to the specified var(capabilities),
+otherwise display the shell's current capabilities.
+)
+findex(getcap)
+cindex(capabilities, getting from files)
+item(tt(getcap) var(filename) ...)(
+This is a built-in implementation of the POSIX standard utility.  It displays
+the capability sets on each specified var(filename).
+)
+findex(setcap)
+cindex(capabilities, setting on files)
+item(tt(setcap) var(capabilities) var(filename) ...)(
+This is a built-in implementation of the POSIX standard utility.  It sets
+the capability sets on each specified var(filename) to the specified
+var(capabilities).
+)
+enditem()
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/mod_clone.yo b/Doc/Zsh/mod_clone.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..9bb7dc255
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/mod_clone.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,19 @@
+texinode(The clone Module)(The comp1 Module)(The cap Module)(Zsh Modules)
+sect(The clone Module)
+The tt(clone) module makes available one builtin command:
+
+startitem()
+findex(clone)
+cindex(shell, cloning)
+cindex(cloning the shell)
+cindex(terminal)
+item(tt(clone) var(tty))(
+Creates a forked instance of the current shell, attached to the specified
+var(tty).  In the new shell, the tt(PID), tt(PPID) and tt(TTY) special
+parameters are changed appropriately.  tt($!) is set to zero in the new
+shell, and to the new shell's PID in the original shell.
+
+The return value of the builtin is zero in both shells if successful,
+and non-zero on error.
+)
+enditem()
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/mod_comp1.yo b/Doc/Zsh/mod_comp1.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..879b6d927
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/mod_comp1.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,11 @@
+texinode(The comp1 Module)(The compctl Module)(The clone Module)(Zsh Modules)
+sect(The comp1 Module)
+The tt(comp1) module does nothing that is visible to the user.
+Its purpose is to provide the internal basis of the programmable
+completion mechanism.
+
+This module must be loaded before any module that
+provides a means of controlling completion (such as the tt(compctl)
+module), or that uses completions (such as the tt(zle) module).
+This is done automatically for modules distributed with zsh, and
+for other modules can be effected by the use of tt(zmodload -d).
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/mod_compctl.yo b/Doc/Zsh/mod_compctl.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..b7adf8fa6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/mod_compctl.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,7 @@
+texinode(The compctl Module)(The deltochar Module)(The comp1 Module)(Zsh Modules)
+sect(The compctl Module)
+The tt(compctl) module makes available one builtin command, tt(compctl),
+which is the standard way to control completions for ZLE.  See
+ifzman(zmanref(zshcompctl))\
+ifnzman(noderef(Programmable Completion))\
+.
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/mod_deltochar.yo b/Doc/Zsh/mod_deltochar.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..f92a3da0d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/mod_deltochar.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,12 @@
+texinode(The deltochar Module)(The example Module)(The compctl Module)(Zsh Modules)
+sect(The deltochar Module)
+The tt(deltochar) module makes available one ZLE function:
+
+startitem()
+tindex(delete-to-char)
+item(tt(delete-to-char))(
+Read a character from the keyboard, and
+delete from the cursor position up to and including the next
+(or, with repeat count var(n), the var(n)th) instance of that character.
+)
+enditem()
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/mod_example.yo b/Doc/Zsh/mod_example.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..5339253d9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/mod_example.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,16 @@
+texinode(The example Module)(The files Module)(The deltochar Module)(Zsh Modules)
+sect(The example Module)
+The tt(example) module makes available one builtin command:
+
+startitem()
+findex(example)
+cindex(modules, example)
+cindex(modules, writing)
+cindex(writing modules)
+item(tt(example) [ tt(-flags) ] [ var(args) ... ])(
+Displays the flags and arguments it is invoked with.
+)
+enditem()
+
+The purpose of the module is to serve as an example of how to write a
+module.
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/mod_files.yo b/Doc/Zsh/mod_files.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..541ebb4a9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/mod_files.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,100 @@
+texinode(The files Module)(The sched Module)(The example Module)(Zsh Modules)
+sect(The files Module)
+cindex(files, manipulating)
+The tt(files) module makes some standard commands available as builtins:
+
+startitem()
+findex(ln)
+xitem(tt(ln) [ tt(-dfis) ] var(filename) var(dest))
+item(tt(ln) [ tt(-dfis) ] var(filename) ... var(dir))(
+Creates hard (or, with tt(-s), symbolic) links.  In the first form, the
+specified var(dest)ination is created, as a link to the specified
+var(filename).  In the second form, each of the var(filename)s is
+taken in turn, and linked to a pathname in the specified var(dir)ectory
+that has the same last pathname component.
+
+Normally, tt(ln) will not attempt to create hard links to
+directories.  This check can be overridden using the tt(-d) option.
+Typically only the super-user can actually succeed in creating
+hard links to directories.
+This does not apply to symbolic links in any case.
+
+By default, existing files cannot be replaced by links.
+The tt(-i) option causes the user to be queried about replacing
+existing files.  The tt(-f) option causes existing files to be
+silently deleted, without querying.  tt(-f) takes precedence.
+)
+findex(mkdir)
+item(tt(mkdir) [ tt(-p) ] [ tt(-m) var(mode) ] var(dir) ...)(
+Creates directories.  With the tt(-p) option, non-existing parent
+directories are first created if necessary, and there will be
+no complaint if the directory already exists.
+The tt(-m) option can be used to specify (in octal) a set of file permissions
+for the created directories, otherwise mode 777 modified by the current
+tt(umask) (see manref(umask)(2)) is used.
+)
+findex(mv)
+xitem(tt(mv) [ tt(-fi) ] var(filename) var(dest))
+item(tt(mv) [ tt(-fi) ] var(filename) ... var(dir))(
+Moves files.  In the first form, the specified var(filename) is moved
+to the specified var(dest)ination.  In the second form, each of the
+var(filename)s is
+taken in turn, and moved to a pathname in the specified var(dir)ectory
+that has the same last pathname component.
+
+By default, the user will be queried before replacing any file
+that the user cannot write to, but writable files will be silently
+removed.
+The tt(-i) option causes the user to be queried about replacing
+any existing files.  The tt(-f) option causes any existing files to be
+silently deleted, without querying.  tt(-f) takes precedence.
+
+Note that this tt(mv) will not move files across devices.
+Historical versions of tt(mv), when actual renaming is impossible,
+fall back on copying and removing files; if this behaviour is desired,
+use tt(cp) and tt(rm) manually.  This may change in a future version.
+)
+findex(rm)
+item(tt(rm) [ tt(-dfirs) ] var(filename) ...)(
+Removes files and directories specified.
+
+Normally, tt(rm) will not remove directories (except with the tt(-r)
+option).  The tt(-d) option causes tt(rm) to try removing directories
+with tt(unlink) (see manref(unlink)(2)), the same method used for files.
+Typically only the super-user can actually succeed in unlinking
+directories in this way.
+tt(-d) takes precedence over tt(-r).
+
+By default, the user will be queried before removing any file
+that the user cannot write to, but writable files will be silently
+removed.
+The tt(-i) option causes the user to be queried about removing
+any files.  The tt(-f) option causes files to be
+silently deleted, without querying, and suppresses all error indications.
+tt(-f) takes precedence.
+
+The tt(-r) option causes tt(rm) to recursively descend into directories,
+deleting all files in the directory before removing the directory with
+the tt(rmdir) system call (see manref(rmdir)(2)).
+
+The tt(-s) option is a zsh extension to tt(rm) functionality.  It enables
+paranoid behaviour, intended to avoid common security problems involving
+a root-run tt(rm) being tricked into removing files other than the ones
+intended.  It will refuse to follow symbolic links, so that (for example)
+``tt(rm /tmp/foo/passwd)'' can't accidentally remove tt(/etc/passwd)
+if tt(/tmp/foo) happens to be a link to tt(/etc).  It will also check
+where it is after leaving directories, so that a recursive removal of
+a deep directory tree can't end up recursively removing tt(/usr) as
+a result of directories being moved up the tree.
+)
+findex(rmdir)
+item(tt(rmdir) var(dir) ...)(
+Removes empty directories specified.
+)
+findex(sync)
+item(tt(sync))(
+Calls the system call of the same name (see manref(sync)(2)), which
+flushes dirty buffers to disk.  It might return before the I/O has
+actually been completed.
+)
+enditem()
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/mod_sched.yo b/Doc/Zsh/mod_sched.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..1be550a79
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/mod_sched.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,17 @@
+texinode(The sched Module)(The stat Module)(The files Module)(Zsh Modules)
+sect(The sched Module)
+The tt(sched) module makes available one builtin command:
+
+startitem()
+findex(sched)
+cindex(timed execution)
+cindex(execution, timed)
+xitem(tt(sched) [tt(PLUS())]var(hh)tt(:)var(mm) var(command) ...)
+item(tt(sched) [ tt(-)var(item) ])(
+Make an entry in the scheduled list of commands to execute.
+The time may be specified in either absolute or relative time.
+With no arguments, prints the list of scheduled commands.
+With the argument `tt(-)var(item)', removes the given item
+from the list.
+)
+enditem()
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/mod_stat.yo b/Doc/Zsh/mod_stat.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..22fbe2a73
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/mod_stat.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,145 @@
+texinode(The stat Module)(The zle Module)(The sched Module)(Zsh Modules)
+sect(The stat Module)
+The tt(stat) module makes available one builtin command:
+
+startitem()
+findex(stat)
+cindex(files, listing)
+cindex(files, examining)
+item(tt(stat) [ tt(-gnNlLtTrs) ] [ tt(-f) var(fd) ] [ tt(-A) var(array) ] \
+    [ tt(-F) var(fmt) ] [ tt(PLUS())var(element) ] [ var(file) ... ])(
+The command acts as a front end to the tt(stat) system call (see
+manref(stat)(2)).
+If the tt(stat) call fails, the appropriate system error message
+printed and status 1 is returned.
+The fields of tt(struct stat) give information about
+the files provided as arguments to the command.  In addition to those
+available from the tt(stat) call, an extra element `tt(link)' is provided.
+These elements are:
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(device))(
+The number of the device on which the file resides.
+)
+item(tt(inode))(
+The unique number of the file on this device (`em(inode)' number).
+)
+item(tt(mode))(
+The mode of the file; that is, the file's type and access permissions.
+With the tt(-s) option, this will
+be returned as a string corresponding to the first column in the
+display of the tt(ls -l) command.
+)
+item(tt(nlink))(
+The number of hard links to the file.
+)
+item(tt(uid))(
+The user ID of the owner of the file.  With the tt(-s)
+option, this is displayed as a user name.
+)
+item(tt(gid))(
+The group ID of the file.  With the tt(-s) option, this
+is displayed as a group name.
+)
+item(tt(rdev))(
+The raw device number.  This is only useful for special devices.
+)
+item(tt(size))(
+The size of the file in bytes.
+)
+xitem(tt(atime))
+xitem(tt(mtime))
+item(tt(ctime))(
+The last access, modification and inode change times
+of the file, respectively, as the number of seconds since
+midnight GMT on 1st January, 1970.  With the tt(-s) option,
+these are printed as strings for the local time zone; the format
+can be altered with the tt(-F) option, and with the tt(-g)
+option the times are in GMT.
+)
+item(tt(blksize))(
+The number of bytes in one allocation block on the
+device on which the file resides.
+)
+item(tt(block))(
+The number of disk blocks used by the file.
+)
+item(tt(link))(
+If the file is a link and the tt(-L) option is in
+effect, this contains the name of the file linked to, otherwise
+it is empty.  Note that if this element is selected (``tt(stat PLUS()link)'')
+then the tt(-L) option is automatically used.
+)
+enditem()
+
+A particular element may be selected by including its name
+preceded by a `tt(PLUS())' in the option list; only one element is allowed.
+The element may be shortened to any unique set of leading
+characters.  Otherwise, all elements will be shown for all files.
+
+Options:
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(-A) var(array))(
+Instead of displaying the results on standard
+output, assign them to an var(array), one tt(struct stat) element per array
+element for each file in order.  In this case neither the name
+of the element nor the name of the files is provided unless the
+tt(-t) or tt(-n) options are provided, respectively.  In the
+former case the element name appears as a prefix to the
+appropriate array element and in the latter case the file name
+appears as a separate array element preceding all the others.
+Other formatting options are respected.
+)
+item(tt(-f) var(fd))(
+Use the file on file descriptor var(fd) instead of
+named files; no list of file names is allowed in this case.
+)
+item(tt(-F) var(fmt))(
+Supplies a tt(strftime) (see manref(strftime)(3)) string for the
+formatting of the time elements.  The tt(-s) option is implied.
+)
+item(tt(-g))(
+Show the time elements in the GMT time zone.  The
+tt(-s) option is implied.
+)
+item(tt(-l))(
+List the names of the type elements (to standard
+output or an array as appropriate) and return immediately;
+options other than tt(-A) and arguments are ignored.
+)
+item(tt(-L))(
+Perform an tt(lstat) (see manref(lstat)(2)) rather than a tt(stat)
+system call.  In this case, if the file is a link, information
+about the link itself rather than the target file is returned.
+This option is required to make the tt(link) element useful.
+)
+item(tt(-n))(
+Always show the names of files.  Usually these are
+only shown when output is to standard output and there is more
+than one file in the list.
+)
+item(tt(-N))(
+Never show the names of files.
+)
+item(tt(-r))(
+Print raw data (the default format) alongside string
+data (the tt(-s) format); the string data appears in parentheses
+after the raw data.
+)
+item(tt(-s))(
+Print tt(mode), tt(uid), tt(gid) and the three time
+elements as strings instead of numbers.  In each case the format
+is like that of tt(ls -l).
+)
+item(tt(-t))(
+Always show the type names for the elements of
+tt(struct stat).  Usually these are only shown when output is to
+standard output and no individual element has been selected.
+)
+item(tt(-T))(
+Never show the type names of the tt(struct stat) elements.
+)
+enditem()
+)
+enditem()
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/mod_zftp.yo b/Doc/Zsh/mod_zftp.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..a15be60d6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/mod_zftp.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,421 @@
+texinode(The zftp Module)(The zle Module)(The stat Module)(Zsh Modules)
+sect(The zftp Module)
+The tt(zftp) module makes available one builtin command:
+
+startitem()
+findex(zftp)
+cindex(FTP)
+cindex(files, transferring)
+item(tt(zftp) var(subcommand) [ var(args) ])(
+The tt(zftp) module is a client for FTP (file transfer protocol).  It
+is implemented as a builtin to allow full use of shell command line
+editing, file I/O, and job control mechanisms.  Often, users will
+access it via shell functions providing higher level abilities such as
+username and password lookup.  However, it is entirely usable in its
+own right.
+
+All commands consist of the command name tt(zftp) followed by the name
+of a subcommand.  These are listed below.  The return status of each
+subcommand is supposed to reflect the success or failure of the remote
+operation.  See a description of the variable tt(ZFTP_VERBOSE) for
+more information on how responses from the server may be printed.
+)
+enditem()
+
+subsect(Subcommands)
+cindex(zftp, subcommands)
+
+startitem()
+cindex(FTP, starting a session)
+item(tt(open) var(host) [ var(user) [ var(password) [ var(account) ] ] ])(
+Open a new FTP session to var(host), which may be the name of a TCP/IP
+connected host or an IP number in the standard dot notation.
+Remaining arguments are passed to the tt(login) subcommand.  Note that
+if no arguments beyond var(host) are supplied, tt(open) will em(not)
+automatically call tt(login).  If no arguments at all are supplied,
+tt(open) will use the parameters set by the tt(params) subcommand.
+
+After a successful open, the shell variables tt(ZFTP_HOST),
+tt(ZFTP_IP) and tt(ZFTP_SYSTEM) are available; see `Variables'
+below.
+)
+xitem(tt(login) [ var(name) [ var(password) [ var(account) ] ] ])
+item(tt(user) [ var(name) [ var(password) [ var(account) ] ] ])(
+Login the user var(name) with parameters var(password) and var(account).
+Any of the parameters can be omitted, and will be read from standard
+input if needed (var(name) is always needed).  If 
+standard input is a terminal, a prompt for each one will be printed on
+standard error and var(password) will not be echoed.  If any of the
+parameters are not used, a warning message is printed.
+
+After a successful login, the shell variables tt(ZFTP_USER),
+tt(ZFTP_ACCOUNT) and tt(ZFTP_PWD) are available; see `Variables'
+below.
+
+This command may be re-issued when a user is already logged in, and
+the server will first be reinitialized for a new user.
+)
+xitem(tt(params) [ var(host) [ var(user) [ var(password) \
+[ var(account) ] ] ] ])
+item(tt(params) tt(-))(
+Store the given parameters for a later tt(open) command with no
+arguments.  Only those given on the command line will be remembered.
+Any of the parameters may, however, be specified as a `tt(?)', which
+may need to be quoted to protect it from shell expansion:  in this case,
+the appropriate parameter will be read from stdin as with the
+tt(login) subcommand, including special handling of var(password).
+
+If no arguments are given, the parameters currently set are printed,
+although the password will appear as a line of stars.
+
+If instead a single `tt(-)' is given, the existing parameters, if any,
+are deleted.  In that case, calling tt(open) with no arguments will
+cause an error.
+
+The list of parameters is not deleted after a tt(close), however it
+will be deleted if the tt(zftp) module is unloaded.
+
+For example,
+
+nofill(tt(zftp params ftp.elsewhere.xx juser '?'))
+
+will store the host tt(ftp.elsewhere.xx) and the user tt(juser) and
+then prompt the user for the corresponding password.
+
+This command may also be used to set up a transfer which then takes
+place completely in the background, freeing tt(zftp) for concurrent
+foreground use.  For example,
+
+nofill(tt(zftp params ftp.soreeyes.ca bubble squeak))
+nofill(tt(LPAR()zftp open; zftp get foo >bar; zftp close)tt(RPAR() &))
+
+--- here, the connection is restricted to a background subshell and
+you are free to open a simultaneous connection in the foreground.
+)
+item(tt(cd) var(directory))(
+Change the remote directory to var(directory).  Also alters the shell
+variable tt(ZFTP_PWD).
+)
+item(tt(cdup))(
+Change the remote directory to the one higher in the directory tree.
+Note that tt(cd ..) will also work correctly on non-UNIX systems.
+)
+item(tt(dir) [ var(args...) ])(
+Give a (verbose) listing of the remote directory.  The var(args) are
+passed directly to the server. The command's behaviour is implementation
+dependent, but a UNIX server will typically interpret var(args) as
+arguments to the tt(ls) command and with no arguments return the
+result of `tt(ls -l)'. The directory is listed to standard output.
+)
+item(tt(ls) [ var(args) ])(
+Give a (short) listing of the remote directory.  With no var(args),
+produces a raw list of the files in the directory, one per line.
+Otherwise, up to vagaries of the server implementation, behaves
+similar to tt(dir).
+)
+item(tt(type) [ var(type) ])(
+Change the type for transfer to var(type), or print the current type
+if var(type) is absent.  The allowed values are `tt(A)' (ASCII),
+`tt(I)' (Image, i.e. binary), or `tt(B)' (a synonym for `tt(I)').
+
+The FTP default for a transfer is ASCII.  However, if tt(zftp) finds
+that the remote host is a UNIX machine with 8-bit byes, it will
+automatically switch to using binary for file transfers upon
+tt(open).  This can subsequently be overridden.
+
+The transfer type is only passed to the remote host when a data
+connection is established; this command involves no network overhead.
+)
+item(tt(ascii))(
+The same as tt(type A).
+)
+item(tt(binary))(
+The same as tt(type I).
+)
+item(tt(mode) [ tt(S) | tt(B) ])(
+Set the mode type to stream (tt(S)) or block (tt(B)).  Stream mode is
+the default; block mode is not widely supported.
+)
+xitem(tt(remote) var(files...))
+item(tt(local) [ var(files...) ])(
+Print the size and last modification time of the remote or local
+files.  If there is more than one item on the list, the name of the
+file is printed first.  The first number is the file size, the second
+is the last modification time of the file in the format
+tt(CCYYMMDDhhmmSS) consisting of year, month, date, hour, minutes and
+seconds in GMT.  Note that this format, including the length, is
+guaranteed, so that time strings can be directly compared via the
+tt([[) builtin's tt(<) and tt(>) operators, even if they are too long
+to be represented as integers.
+
+Not all servers support the commands for retrieving this information.
+In that case, the tt(remote) command will print nothing and return
+status 2, compared with status 1 for a file not found.
+
+The tt(local) command (but not tt(remote)) may be used with no
+arguments, in which case the information comes from examining file
+descriptor zero.  This is the same file as seen by a tt(put) command
+with no further redirection.
+)
+item(tt(get) var(file) [...])(
+Retrieve all var(file)s from the server, concatenating them
+and sending them to standard output.
+)
+item(tt(put) var(file) [...])(
+For each var(file), read a file from standard input and send that to
+the remote host with the given name.
+)
+item(tt(append) var(file) [...])(
+As tt(put), but if the remote var(file) already exists, data is
+appended to it instead of overwriting it.
+)
+xitem(tt(getat) var(file) var(point))
+xitem(tt(putat) var(file) var(point))
+item(tt(appendat) var(file) var(point))(
+Versions of tt(get), tt(put) and tt(append) which will start the
+transfer at the given var(point) in the remote var(file).  This is
+useful for appending to an incomplete local file.  However, note that
+this ability is not universally supported by servers (and is not quite
+the behaviour specified by the standard).
+)
+item(tt(delete) var(file) [...])(
+Delete the list of files on the server.
+)
+item(tt(mkdir) var(directory))(
+Create a new directory var(directory) on the server.
+)
+item(tt(rmdir) var(directory))(
+Delete the diretory var(directory)  on the server.
+)
+item(tt(rename) var(old-name) var(new-name))(
+Rename file var(old-name) to var(new-name) on the server.
+)
+item(tt(site) var(args...))(
+Send a host-specific command to the server.  You will probably
+only need this if instructed by the server to use it.
+)
+item(tt(quote) var(args...))(
+Send the raw FTP command sequence to the server.  You should be
+familiar with the FTP command set as defined in RFC959 before doing
+this.  Useful comands may include tt(STAT) and tt(HELP).  Note also
+the mechanism for returning messages as described for the variable
+tt(ZFTP_VERBOSE) below, in particular that all messages from the
+control connection are sent to standard error.
+)
+xitem(tt(close))
+item(tt(quit))(
+Close the current data connection.  This unsets the shell parameters
+tt(ZFTP_HOST), tt(ZFTP_IP), tt(ZFTP_SYSTEM), tt(ZFTP_USER),
+tt(ZFTP_ACCOUNT) and tt(ZFTP_PWD).
+)
+enditem()
+
+subsect(Parameters)
+cindex(zftp, parameters)
+The following shell parameters are used by tt(zftp).  Currently none
+of them are special.
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(ZFTP_TMOUT))(
+Integer.  The time in seconds to wait for a network operation to
+complete before returning an error.  If this is not set when the
+module is loaded, it will be given the default value 60.  A value of
+zero turns off timeouts.  If a timeout occurs on the control
+connection it will be closed.  Use a larger value if this occurs too
+frequently.
+)
+vindex(ZFTP_IP)
+item(tt(ZFTP_IP))(
+Readonly.  The IP address of the current connection in dot notation.
+)
+vindex(ZFTP_HOST)
+item(tt(ZFTP_HOST))(
+Readonly.  The hostname of the current remote server.  If the host was
+opened as an IP number, tt(ZFTP_HOST) contains that instead; this
+saves the overhead for a name lookup, as IP numbers are most commonly
+used when a nameserver is unavailable.
+)
+vindex(ZFTP_SYSTEM)
+item(tt(ZFTP_SYSTEM))(
+Readonly.  The system type string returned by the server in response
+to an FTP tt(SYST) request.  The most interesting case is a string
+beginning tt("UNIX Type: L8"), which ensures maximum compatibility
+with a local UNIX host.
+)
+vindex(ZFTP_TYPE)
+item(tt(ZFTP_TYPE))(
+Readonly.  The type to be used for data transfers , either `tt(A)' or
+`tt(I)'.   Use the tt(type) subcommand to change this.
+)
+vindex(ZFTP_USER)
+item(tt(ZFTP_USER))(
+Readonly.  The username currently logged in, if any.
+)
+vindex(ZFTP_ACCT)
+item(tt(ZFTP_ACCT))(
+Readonly.  The account name of the current user, if any.  Most servers
+do not require an account name.
+)
+vindex(ZFTP_PWD)
+item(tt(ZFTP_PWD))(
+Readonly.  The current directory on the server.
+)
+vindex(ZFTP_CODE)
+item(tt(ZFTP_CODE))(
+Readonly.  The three digit code of the last FTP reply from the server
+as a string.  This can still be read after the connection is closed.
+)
+vindex(ZFTP_REPLY)
+item(tt(ZFTP_REPLY))(
+Readonly.  The last line of the last reply sent by the server.  This
+can still be read after the connection is closed.
+)
+vindex(ZFTP_PREFS)
+item(tt(ZFTP_PREFS))(
+A string of preferences for altering aspects of tt(zftp)'s behaviour.
+Each preference is a single character.  The following are defined:
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(P))(
+Passive:  attempt to make the remote server initiate data transfers.
+This is slightly more efficient than sendport mode.  If the letter
+tt(S) occurs later in the string, tt(zftp) will use sendport mode if
+passive mode is not available.
+)
+item(tt(S))(
+Sendport:  initiate transfers by the FTP tt(PORT) command.  If this
+occurs before any tt(P) in the string, passive mode will never be
+attempted.
+)
+item(tt(D))(
+Dumb:  use only the bare minimum of FTP commands.  This prevents
+the variables tt(ZFTP_SYSTEM) and tt(ZFTP_PWD) from being set, and
+will mean all connections default to ASCII type.  It may prevent
+tt(ZFTP_SIZE) from being set during a transfer if the server
+does not send it anyway (many servers do).
+)
+enditem()
+
+If tt(ZFTP_PREFS) is not set when tt(zftp) is loaded, it will be set to a
+default of `tt(PS)', i.e. use passive mode if available, otherwise
+fall back to sendport mode.
+)
+vindex(ZFTP_VERBOSE)
+item(tt(ZFTP_VERBOSE))(
+A string of digits between 0 and 5 inclusive, specifying which
+responses from the server should be printed.  All responses go to
+standard error.  If any of the numbers 1 to 5 appear in the string,
+raw responses from the server with reply codes beginning with that
+digit will be printed to standard error.  The first digit of the three
+digit reply code is defined by RFC959 to correspond to:
+
+startitem()
+item(1.)(
+A positive prelimnary reply.
+)
+item(2.)(
+A positive completion reply.
+)
+item(3.)(
+A positive intermediate reply.
+)
+item(4.)(
+A transient negative completion reply.
+)
+item(5.)(
+A permanent negative completion reply.
+)
+enditem()
+
+It should be noted that, for unknown reasons, the reply `Service not
+available', which forces termination of a connection, is classified as
+421, i.e. `transient negative', an interesting interpretation of the word
+`transient'.
+
+The code 0 is special:  it indicates that all but the last line of
+multiline replies read from the server will be printed to standard
+error in a processed format.  By convention, servers use this
+mechanism for sending information for the user to read.  The
+appropriate reply code, if it matches the same response, takes
+priority.
+
+If tt(ZFTP_VERBOSE) is not set when tt(zftp) is loaded, it will be
+set to the default value tt(450), i.e., messages destined for the user
+and all errors will be printed.  A null string is valid and
+specifies that no messages should be printed.
+)
+enditem()
+
+subsect(Functions)
+cindex(zftp, functions)
+
+startitem()
+findex(zftp_chpwd)
+item(tt(zftp_chpwd))(
+If this function is set by the user, it is called every time the
+directory changes on the server, including when a user is logged
+in, or when a connection is closed.  In the last case, tt($ZFTP_PWD)
+will be unset; otherwise it will reflect the new directory.
+)
+findex(zftp_progress)
+item(tt(zftp_progress))(
+If this function is set by the user, it will be called during
+a tt(get), tt(put) or tt(append) operation each time sufficient data
+has been received from the host.  During a tt(get), the data is sent
+to standard output, so it is vital that this function should write
+to standard error or directly to the terminal, em(not) to standard
+output.
+
+When it is called with a transfer in progress, the following
+additional shell parameters are set:
+
+startitem()
+vindex(ZFTP_FILE)
+item(tt(ZFTP_FILE))(
+The name of the remote file being transferred from or to.
+)
+vindex(ZFTP_TRANSFER)
+item(tt(ZFTP_TRANSFER))(
+A tt(G) for a tt(get) operation and a tt(P) for a tt(put) operation.
+)
+vindex(ZFTP_SIZE)
+item(tt(ZFTP_SIZE))(
+The total size of the complete file being transferred:
+the same as the first value provided by the
+tt(remote) and tt(local) subcommands for a particular file.
+If the server cannot supply this value for a remote file being
+retrieved, it will not be set.  If input is from a pipe the value may
+be incorrect and correspond simply to a full pipe buffer.
+)
+vindex(ZFTP_COUNT)
+item(tt(ZFTP_COUNT))(
+The amount of data so far transferred; a number between zero and
+tt($ZFTP_SIZE), if that is set.  This number is always available.
+)
+enditem()
+
+The function is initially called with tt(ZFTP_TRANSFER) set
+appropriately and tt(ZFTP_COUNT) set to zero.  After the transfer is
+finished, the function will be called one more time with
+tt(ZFTP_TRANSFER) set to tt(GF) or tt(PF), in case it wishes to tidy
+up.  It is otherwise never called twice with the same value of
+tt(ZFTP_COUNT).
+
+Sometimes the progress meter may cause disruption.  It is up to the
+user to decide whether the function should be defined and to use
+tt(unfunction) when necessary.
+)
+
+subsect(Problems)
+cindex(zftp, problems)
+
+With the exception noted for the tt(params) subcommand, a connection
+may not be opened in the left hand side of a pipe as this occurs in a
+subshell and the file information is not updated in the main shell.
+In the case of type or mode changes or closing the connection in a
+subshell, the information is returned but variables are not updated
+until the next call to tt(zftp).  Other status changes in subshells
+will not be reflected by changes to the variables (but should
+be otherwise harmless).
+
+enditem()
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/mod_zle.yo b/Doc/Zsh/mod_zle.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..9aa03f7f8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/mod_zle.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,193 @@
+texinode(The zle Module)()(The stat Module)(Zsh Modules)
+sect(The zle Module)
+The tt(zle) module contains the Zsh Line Editor.  See
+ifzman(zmanref(zshzle))\
+ifnzman(noderef(Zsh Line Editor))\
+.  It also contains three related builtin commands:
+
+startitem()
+findex(bindkey)
+cindex(keys, rebinding)
+cindex(rebinding keys)
+cindex(keys, binding)
+cindex(binding keys)
+cindex(keymaps)
+xitem(tt(bindkey) [ var(options) ] tt(-l))
+xitem(tt(bindkey) [ var(options) ] tt(-d))
+xitem(tt(bindkey) [ var(options) ] tt(-D) var(keymap) ...)
+xitem(tt(bindkey) [ var(options) ] tt(-A) var(old-keymap new-keymap))
+xitem(tt(bindkey) [ var(options) ] tt(-N) var(new-keymap) [ var(old-keymap) ])
+xitem(tt(bindkey) [ var(options) ] tt(-m))
+xitem(tt(bindkey) [ var(options) ] tt(-r) var(in-string) ...)
+xitem(tt(bindkey) [ var(options) ] tt(-s) var(in-string out-string) ...)
+xitem(tt(bindkey) [ var(options) ] var(in-string command) ...)
+item(tt(bindkey) [ var(options) ] [ var(in-string) ])(
+tt(bindkey)'s options can be divided into three categories: keymap selection,
+operation selection, and others.  The keymap selection options are:
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(-e))(
+Selects keymap `tt(emacs)', and also links it to `tt(main)'.
+)
+item(tt(-v))(
+Selects keymap `tt(viins)', and also links it to `tt(main)'.
+)
+item(tt(-a))(
+Selects keymap `tt(vicmd)'.
+)
+item(tt(-M))(
+The first non-option argument is used as a keymap name,
+and does not otherwise count as an argument.
+)
+enditem()
+
+Some operations do not permit a keymap to be selected.
+If a keymap selection is required and none of the options above are used, the
+`tt(main)' keymap is used.  These operations do not permit a keymap to be
+selected:
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(-l))(
+List all existing keymap names.  If the tt(-L)
+option is used, list in the form of tt(bindkey)
+commands to create the keymaps.
+)
+item(tt(-d))(
+Delete all existing keymaps and reset to the default state.
+)
+item(tt(-D) var(keymap) ...)(
+Delete the named var(keymap)s.
+)
+item(tt(-A) var(old-keymap new-keymap))(
+Make the var(new-keymap) name an alias for var(old-keymap), so that
+both names refer to the same keymap.  The names have equal standing;
+if either is deleted, the other remains.  If there is already a keymap
+with the var(new-keymap) name, it is deleted.
+)
+item(tt(-N) var(new-keymap) [ var(old-keymap) ])(
+Create a new keymap, named var(new-keymap).  If a keymap already has that
+name, it is deleted.  If an var(old-keymap) name is given, the new keymap
+is initialised to be a duplicate of it, otherwise the new keymap will
+be empty.
+)
+enditem()
+
+The following operations require a keymap to be selected:
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(-m))(
+Add the built-in set of meta-key bindings to the selected keymap.
+Only keys that are unbound or bound to tt(self-insert) are affected.
+)
+item(tt(-r) var(in-string) ...)(
+Unbind the specified var(in-string)s in the selected keymap.
+This is exactly equivalent to binding the strings to tt(undefined-key).
+)
+item(tt(-s) var(in-string out-string) ...)(
+Bind each var(in-string) to each var(out-string).
+When var(in-string) is typed, var(out-string) will be
+pushed back and treated as input to the line editor.
+)
+item(var(in-string command) ...)(
+Bind each var(in-string) to each var(command).
+)
+item([ var(in-string) ])(
+List key bindings.  If an var(in-string) is specified, the binding of
+that string in the selected keymap is displayed.  Otherwise, all key
+bindings in the selected keymap are displayed.  As an exception,
+if the tt(-e) or tt(-v) options are used alone, the keymap is em(not)
+displayed - the implicit linking of keymaps is the only thing that happens.
+)
+enditem()
+
+In the binding operations, if the tt(-R) option is used, the var(in-string)s
+are interpreted as ranges, instead of plain strings.  A valid range
+consists of two characters, with an optional `tt(-)'
+between them.  All characters between the two specified, inclusive,
+are bound as specified.
+
+For either var(in-string) or var(out-string), the following
+escape sequences are recognised:
+
+startsitem()
+sitem(tt(\a))(bell character)
+sitem(tt(\b))(backspace)
+sitem(tt(\e), tt(\E))(escape)
+sitem(tt(\f))(form feed)
+sitem(tt(\n))(linefeed (newline))
+sitem(tt(\r))(carriage return)
+sitem(tt(\t))(horizontal tab)
+sitem(tt(\v))(vertical tab)
+sitem(tt(\)var(NNN))(character code in octal)
+sitem(tt(\x)var(NN))(character code in hexadecimal)
+sitem(tt(\M)[tt(-)]var(X))(character with meta bit set)
+sitem(tt(\C)[tt(-)]var(X))(control character)
+sitem(tt(^)var(X))(control character)
+endsitem()
+
+In all other cases, `tt(\)' escapes the following character.  Delete is
+written as `tt(^?)'.  Note that `tt(\M^?)' and `tt(^\M?)' are not the same.
+)
+findex(vared)
+cindex(parameters, editing)
+cindex(editing parameters)
+item(tt(vared) [ tt(-ch) ] [ tt(-p) var(prompt) ] [ tt(-r) var(rprompt) ] var(name))(
+The value of the parameter var(name) is loaded into the edit
+buffer, and the line editor is invoked.  When the editor exits,
+var(name) is set to the string value returned by the editor.
+If the tt(-c) flag is given, the parameter is created if it doesn't
+already exist.
+If the tt(-p) flag is given, the following string will be taken as
+the prompt to display at the left.  If the tt(-r) flag is given,
+the following string gives the prompt to display at the right.  If the
+tt(-h) flag is specified, the history can be accessed from ZLE.
+)
+findex(zle)
+cindex(widgets, rebinding)
+cindex(rebinding widgets)
+cindex(widgets, binding)
+cindex(binding widgets)
+cindex(widgets, invoking)
+cindex(invoking widgets)
+cindex(widgets, calling)
+cindex(calling widgets)
+cindex(widgets, defining)
+cindex(defining widgets)
+xitem(tt(zle) tt(-l) [ tt(-L) ])
+xitem(tt(zle) tt(-D) var(widget) ...)
+xitem(tt(zle) tt(-A) var(old-widget) var(new-widget))
+xitem(tt(zle) tt(-N) var(widget) [ var(function) ])
+item(tt(zle) var(widget))(
+The tt(zle) builtin performs a number of different actions concerning
+ZLE.  Which operation it performs depends on its options:
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(-l) [ tt(-L) ])(
+List all existing user-defined widgets.  If the tt(-L)
+option is used, list in the form of tt(zle)
+commands to create the widgets.
+Built-in widgets are not listed.
+)
+item(tt(-D) var(widget) ...)(
+Delete the named var(widget)s.
+)
+item(tt(-A) var(old-widget) var(new-widget))(
+Make the var(new-widget) name an alias for var(old-widget), so that
+both names refer to the same widget.  The names have equal standing;
+if either is deleted, the other remains.  If there is already a widget
+with the var(new-widget) name, it is deleted.
+)
+item(tt(-N) var(widget) [ var(function) ])(
+Create a user-defined widget.  If there is already a widget with the
+specified name, it is overwritten.  When the new
+widget is invoked from within the editor, the specified shell var(function)
+is called.  If no function name is specified, it defaults to
+the same name as the widget.
+)
+item(var(widget))(
+Invoke the specified widget.  This can only be done when ZLE is
+active; normally this will be within a user-defined widget.
+)
+enditem()
+)
+enditem()
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/modules.yo b/Doc/Zsh/modules.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..b44b00e6b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/modules.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,64 @@
+texinode(Zsh Modules)()(Programmable Completion)(Top)
+chapter(Zsh Modules)
+cindex(modules)
+sect(Description)
+Some optional parts of zsh are in modules, separate from the core
+of the shell.  Each of these modules may be linked in to the
+shell at build time,
+or can be dynamically linked while the shell is running
+if the installation supports this feature.  The modules available are:
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(cap))(
+Builtins for manipulating POSIX.1e (POSIX.6) capability (privilege) sets.
+)
+item(tt(clone))(
+A builtin that can clone a running shell onto another terminal.
+)
+item(tt(comp1))(
+Base of the completion system.  Used by the tt(compctl) and tt(zle) modules.
+)
+item(tt(compctl))(
+The tt(compctl) builtin for controlling completion.
+)
+item(tt(deltochar))(
+A ZLE function duplicating EMACS' tt(zap-to-char).
+)
+item(tt(example))(
+An example of how to write a module.
+)
+item(tt(files))(
+Some basic file manipulation commands as builtins.
+)
+item(tt(sched))(
+A builtin that provides a timed execution facility within the shell.
+)
+item(tt(stat))(
+A builtin command interface to the tt(stat) system call.
+)
+item(tt(zle))(
+The Zsh Line Editor, including the tt(bindkey) and tt(vared) builtins.
+)
+enditem()
+startmenu()
+menu(The cap Module)
+menu(The clone Module)
+menu(The comp1 Module)
+menu(The compctl Module)
+menu(The deltochar Module)
+menu(The example Module)
+menu(The files Module)
+menu(The sched Module)
+menu(The stat Module)
+menu(The zle Module)
+endmenu()
+includefile(Zsh/mod_cap.yo)
+includefile(Zsh/mod_clone.yo)
+includefile(Zsh/mod_comp1.yo)
+includefile(Zsh/mod_compctl.yo)
+includefile(Zsh/mod_deltochar.yo)
+includefile(Zsh/mod_example.yo)
+includefile(Zsh/mod_files.yo)
+includefile(Zsh/mod_sched.yo)
+includefile(Zsh/mod_stat.yo)
+includefile(Zsh/mod_zle.yo)
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/options.yo b/Doc/Zsh/options.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..0fdf78e8a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/options.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,1039 @@
+texinode(Options)(Shell Builtin Commands)(Parameters)(Top)
+chapter(Options)
+cindex(options)
+startmenu()
+menu(Specifying Options)
+menu(Description of Options)
+menu(Option Aliases)
+menu(Single Letter Options)
+endmenu()
+texinode(Specifying Options)(Description of Options)()(Options)
+sect(Specifying Options)
+cindex(options, specifying)
+Options are primarily referred to by name.
+These names are case insensitive and underscores are ignored.
+For example, `tt(allexport)' is equivalent to `tt(A__lleXP_ort)'.
+
+The sense of an option name may be inverted by preceding it with
+`tt(no)', so `tt(setopt No_Beep)' is equivalent to `tt(unsetopt beep)'.
+This inversion can only be done once, so `tt(nonobeep)' is em(not)
+a synonym for `tt(beep)'.  Similarly, `tt(tify)' is not a synonym for
+`tt(nonotify)' (the inversion of `tt(notify)').
+
+Some options also have one or more single letter names.
+There are two sets of single letter options: one used by default,
+and another used to emulate bf(sh)/bf(ksh) (used when the
+tt(SH_OPTION_LETTERS) option is set).
+The single letter options can be used on the shell command line,
+or with the tt(set), tt(setopt) and tt(unsetopt)
+builtins, as normal Unix options preceded by `tt(-)'.
+
+The sense of the single letter options may be inverted by using
+`tt(PLUS())' instead of `tt(-)'.
+Some of the single letter option names refer to an option being off,
+in which case the inversion of that name refers to the option being on.
+For example, `tt(PLUS()n)' is the short name of `tt(exec)', and
+`tt(-n)' is the short name of its inversion, `tt(noexec)'.
+texinode(Description of Options)(Option Aliases)(Specifying Options)(Options)
+sect(Description of Options)
+cindex(options, description)
+startitem()
+pindex(ALL_EXPORT)
+cindex(export, automatic)
+item(tt(ALL_EXPORT) (tt(-a), ksh: tt(-a)))(
+All parameters subsequently defined are automatically exported.
+)
+pindex(ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT)
+item(tt(ALWAYS_LAST_PROMPT))(
+If unset, key functions that list completions try to return to the last
+prompt if given a numeric argument. If set these functions try to
+return to the last prompt if given em(no) numeric argument.
+)
+pindex(ALWAYS_TO_END)
+item(tt(ALWAYS_TO_END))(
+If a completion is performed with the cursor within a word, and a
+full completion is inserted, the cursor is moved to the end of the
+word.  That is, the cursor is moved to the end of the word if either
+a single match is inserted or menu completion is performed.
+)
+pindex(APPEND_HISTORY)
+cindex(history, appending to a file)
+item(tt(APPEND_HISTORY))(
+If this is set, zsh sessions will append their history list to
+the history file, rather than overwrite it. Thus, multiple parallel
+zsh sessions will all have their history lists added to the
+history file, in the order they are killed.
+)
+pindex(AUTO_CD)
+cindex(cd, automatic)
+item(tt(AUTO_CD) (tt(-J)))(
+If a command is issued that can't be executed as a normal command,
+and the command is the name of a directory, perform the tt(cd)
+command to that directory.
+)
+pindex(AUTO_LIST)
+cindex(completion, listing choices)
+item(tt(AUTO_LIST) (tt(-9)))(
+Automatically list choices on an ambiguous completion.
+)
+pindex(AUTO_MENU)
+cindex(completion, menu)
+item(tt(AUTO_MENU))(
+Automatically use menu completion after the second consecutive request for
+completion, for example by pressing the tab key repeatedly. This option
+is overridden by tt(MENU_COMPLETE).
+)
+pindex(AUTO_NAME_DIRS)
+cindex(directories, named)
+item(tt(AUTO_NAME_DIRS))(
+Any parameter that is set to the absolute name of a directory
+immediately becomes a name for that directory, that will be used
+by the `tt(%~)'
+and related prompt sequences, and will be available when completion
+is performed on a word starting with `tt(~)'.
+(Otherwise, the parameter must be used in the form `tt(~)var(param)' first.)
+)
+pindex(AUTO_PARAM_KEYS)
+item(tt(AUTO_PARAM_KEYS))(
+If a parameter name was completed and a following character
+(normally a space) automatically
+inserted, and the next character typed is one
+of those that have to come directly after the name (like `tt(})', `tt(:)',
+etc.), the automatically added character is deleted, so that the character
+typed comes immediately after the parameter name.
+Completion in a brace expansion is affected similarly: the added character
+is a `tt(,)', which will be removed if `tt(})' is typed next.
+)
+pindex(AUTO_PARAM_SLASH)
+item(tt(AUTO_PARAM_SLASH))(
+If a parameter is completed whose content is the name of a directory,
+then add a trailing slash instead of a space.
+)
+pindex(AUTO_PUSHD)
+cindex(cd, behaving like pushd)
+cindex(pushd, making cd behave like)
+item(tt(AUTO_PUSHD) (tt(-N)))(
+Make tt(cd) push the old directory onto the directory stack.
+)
+pindex(AUTO_REMOVE_SLASH)
+cindex(slash, removing trailing)
+item(tt(AUTO_REMOVE_SLASH))(
+When the last character resulting from a completion is a slash and the next
+character typed is a word delimiter or a slash, remove the slash.
+)
+pindex(AUTO_RESUME)
+cindex(jobs, resuming automatically)
+cindex(resuming jobs automatically)
+item(tt(AUTO_RESUME) (tt(-W)))(
+Treat single word simple commands without redirection
+as candidates for resumption of an existing job.
+)
+pindex(BAD_PATTERN)
+cindex(globbing, bad pattern)
+cindex(filename generation, bad pattern)
+item(tt(BAD_PATTERN) (tt(PLUS()2)))(
+If a pattern for filename generation is badly formed, print an error message.
+(If this option is unset, the pattern will be left unchanged.)
+)
+pindex(BANG_HIST)
+cindex(history, enable substitution)
+cindex(enable history substitution)
+item(tt(BANG_HIST) (tt(PLUS()K)))(
+Perform textual history substitution, bf(csh)-style,
+treating the character `tt(!)' specially.
+)
+pindex(BARE_GLOB_QUAL)
+cindex(globbing qualifiers, enable)
+cindex(enable globbing qualifiers)
+item(tt(BARE_GLOB_QUAL))(
+In a glob pattern, treat a trailing set of parentheses as a qualifier
+list, if it contains no `tt(|)', `tt(LPAR())' or (if special) `tt(~)'
+characters.  See noderef(Filename Generation).
+)
+pindex(BEEP)
+cindex(beep, enabling)
+cindex(enabling the beep)
+item(tt(BEEP) (tt(PLUS()B)))(
+Beep on error in ZLE.
+)
+pindex(BG_NICE)
+cindex(jobs, background priority)
+cindex(background jobs, priority of)
+cindex(priority of background jobs)
+item(tt(BG_NICE) (tt(-6)))(
+Run all background jobs at a lower priority.  This option
+is set by default.
+)
+pindex(BRACE_CCL)
+cindex(brace expansion, extending)
+cindex(expansion, brace, extending)
+item(tt(BRACE_CCL))(
+Expand expressions in braces which would not otherwise undergo brace
+expansion to a lexically ordered list of all the characters.  See
+noderef(Brace Expansion).
+)
+pindex(BSD_ECHO)
+cindex(echo, BSD compatible)
+item(tt(BSD_ECHO))(
+Make the tt(echo) builtin compatible with the BSD manref(echo)(1) command.
+This disables backslashed escape sequences in echo strings unless the
+tt(-e) option is specified.
+)
+pindex(CDABLE_VARS)
+cindex(cd, to parameter)
+item(tt(CDABLE_VARS) (tt(-T)))(
+If the argument to a tt(cd) command (or an implied tt(cd) with the
+tt(AUTO_CD) option set) is not a directory, and does not begin with a
+slash, try to expand the expression as if it were preceded by a `tt(~)' (see
+noderef(Filename Expansion)).
+)
+pindex(CHASE_LINKS)
+cindex(links, symbolic)
+cindex(symbolic links)
+item(tt(CHASE_LINKS) (tt(-w)))(
+Resolve symbolic links to their true values when changing directory.
+)
+pindex(CLOBBER)
+cindex(clobbering, of files)
+cindex(file clobbering, allowing)
+item(tt(CLOBBER) (tt(PLUS()C), ksh: tt(PLUS()C)))(
+Allows `tt(>)' redirection to truncate existing files,
+and `tt(>>)' to create files.
+Otherwise `tt(>!)' or `tt(>|)' must be used to truncate a file,
+and `tt(>>!)' or `tt(>>|)' to create a file.
+)
+pindex(COMPLETE_ALIASES)
+cindex(aliases, completion of)
+item(tt(COMPLETE_ALIASES))(
+Prevents aliases on the command line from being internally substituted
+before completion is attempted.  The effect is to make the alias a
+distinct command for completion purposes.
+)
+pindex(COMPLETE_IN_WORD)
+item(tt(COMPLETE_IN_WORD))(
+If unset, the cursor is set to the end of the word if completion is
+started. Otherwise it stays there and completion is done from both ends.
+)
+pindex(CORRECT)
+cindex(correction, spelling)
+cindex(spelling correction)
+item(tt(CORRECT) (tt(-0)))(
+Try to correct the spelling of commands.
+)
+pindex(CORRECT_ALL)
+item(tt(CORRECT_ALL) (tt(-O)))(
+Try to correct the spelling of all arguments in a line.
+)
+pindex(CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY)
+cindex(csh, history style)
+cindex(history style, csh)
+item(tt(CSH_JUNKIE_HISTORY))(
+A history reference without an event specifier will always refer to the
+previous command.  Without this option, such a history reference refers
+to the same event as the previous history reference, defaulting to the
+previous command.
+)
+pindex(CSH_JUNKIE_LOOPS)
+cindex(csh, loop style)
+cindex(loop style, csh)
+item(tt(CSH_JUNKIE_LOOPS))(
+Allow loop bodies to take the form `var(list); tt(end)' instead of
+`tt(do) var(list); tt(done)'.
+)
+pindex(CSH_JUNKIE_QUOTES)
+cindex(csh, quoting style)
+cindex(quoting style, csh)
+item(tt(CSH_JUNKIE_QUOTES))(
+Changes the rules for single- and double-quoted text to match that of
+bf(csh).  These require that embedded newlines be preceded by a backslash;
+unescaped newlines will cause an error message.
+In double-quoted strings, it is made impossible to escape `tt($)', `tt(`)'
+or `tt(")' (and `tt(\)' itself no longer needs escaping).
+Command substitutions are only expanded once, and cannot be nested.
+)
+pindex(CSH_NULL_GLOB)
+cindex(csh, null globbing style)
+cindex(null globbing style, csh)
+cindex(globbing, null, style, csh)
+item(tt(CSH_NULL_GLOB))(
+If a pattern for filename generation has no matches,
+delete the pattern from the argument list;
+do not report an error unless all the patterns
+in a command have no matches.
+Overrides tt(NULL_GLOB).
+)
+pindex(EQUALS)
+cindex(filename substitution, =)
+item(tt(EQUALS))(
+Perform tt(=) filename substitution.
+(See noderef(Filename Expansion).)
+)
+pindex(ERR_EXIT)
+cindex(exit status, trapping)
+item(tt(ERR_EXIT) (tt(-e), ksh: tt(-e)))(
+If a command has a non-zero exit status, execute the tt(ZERR)
+trap, if set, and exit.  This is disabled while running initialization
+scripts.
+)
+pindex(EXEC)
+cindex(command execution, enabling)
+item(tt(EXEC) (tt(PLUS()n), ksh: tt(PLUS()n)))(
+Do execute commands.  Without this option, commands are
+read and checked for syntax errors, but not executed.
+)
+pindex(EXTENDED_GLOB)
+cindex(globbing, extended)
+item(tt(EXTENDED_GLOB))(
+Treat the `tt(#)', `tt(~)' and `tt(^)' characters as part of patterns
+for filename generation, etc.  (An initial unquoted `tt(~)'
+always produces named directory expansion.)
+)
+pindex(EXTENDED_HISTORY)
+cindex(history, timestamping)
+item(tt(EXTENDED_HISTORY))(
+Save beginning and ending timestamps to the history file.
+The format of these timestamps is
+`tt(:)var(<beginning time>)tt(:)var(<ending time>)tt(:)var(<command>)'.
+)
+pindex(FLOW_CONTROL)
+cindex(flow control)
+item(tt(FLOW_CONTROL))(
+If this option is unset,
+output flow control via start/stop characters (usually assigned to
+^S/^Q) is disabled in the shell's editor.
+)
+pindex(FUNCTION_ARGZERO)
+cindex($0, setting)
+item(tt(FUNCTION_ARGZERO))(
+When executing a shell function or sourcing a script, set tt($0)
+temporarily to the name of the function/script.
+)
+pindex(GLOB)
+cindex(globbing, enabling)
+cindex(enabling globbing)
+item(tt(GLOB) (tt(PLUS()F), ksh: tt(PLUS()f)))(
+Perform filename generation (globbing).
+(See noderef(Filename Generation).)
+)
+pindex(GLOB_ASSIGN)
+item(tt(GLOB_ASSIGN))(
+If this option is set, filename generation (globbing) is
+performed on the right hand side of scalar parameter assignments of
+the form `var(name)tt(=)var(pattern) (e.g. `tt(foo=*)').
+If the result has more than one word the parameter will become an array
+with those words as arguments. This option is provided for backwards
+compatibility only: globbing is always performed on the right hand side
+of array assignments of the form `var(name)tt(=LPAR())var(value)tt(RPAR())'
+(e.g. `tt(foo=(*))') and this form is recommended for clarity;
+with this option set, it is not possible to predict whether the result
+will be an array or a scalar.
+)
+pindex(GLOB_COMPLETE)
+item(tt(GLOB_COMPLETE))(
+When the current word has a glob pattern, do not insert all the words
+resulting from the expansion but cycle through them like
+tt(MENU_COMPLETE). If no matches are found, a `tt(*)' is added to the end of the
+word or inserted at the cursor if tt(COMPLETE_IN_WORD) is set, and expansion
+is attempted again.  Using patterns works not only for files but for all
+completions, such as options, user names, etc.
+)
+pindex(GLOB_DOTS)
+cindex(globbing, of . files)
+item(tt(GLOB_DOTS) (tt(-4)))(
+Do not require a leading `tt(.)' in a filename to be matched explicitly.
+)
+pindex(GLOB_SUBST)
+item(tt(GLOB_SUBST))(
+Treat any characters resulting from parameter substitution as being
+eligible for file expansion and filename generation, and any
+characters resulting from command substitution as being eligible for
+filename generation.
+)
+pindex(HASH_CMDS)
+cindex(hashing, of commands)
+cindex(command hashing)
+item(tt(HASH_CMDS))(
+Note the location of each command the first time it is executed.
+Subsequent invocations of the same command will use the
+saved location, avoiding a path search.
+If this option is unset, no path hashing will be done at all.
+)
+pindex(HASH_DIRS)
+cindex(hashing, of directories)
+cindex(directories, hashing)
+item(tt(HASH_DIRS))(
+Whenever a command is executed, hash the directory containing it,
+as well as all directories that occur earlier in the path.
+Has no effect if tt(HASH_CMDS) is unset.
+)
+pindex(HASH_LIST_ALL)
+item(tt(HASH_LIST_ALL))(
+Whenever a command completion is attempted, make sure the entire
+command path is hashed first.  This makes the first completion slower.
+)
+pindex(HIST_ALLOW_CLOBBER)
+item(tt(HIST_ALLOW_CLOBBER))(
+Add `tt(|)' to output redirections in the history.  This allows history
+references to clobber files even when tt(CLOBBER) is unset.
+)
+pindex(HIST_BEEP)
+cindex(history beeping)
+cindex(beep, history)
+item(tt(HIST_BEEP))(
+Beep when an attempt is made to access a history entry which
+isn't there.
+)
+pindex(HIST_IGNORE_DUPS)
+cindex(history, ignoring duplicates)
+item(tt(HIST_IGNORE_DUPS) (tt(-h)))(
+Do not enter command lines into the history list
+if they are duplicates of the previous event.
+)
+pindex(HIST_IGNORE_SPACE)
+cindex(history, ignoring spaces)
+item(tt(HIST_IGNORE_SPACE) (tt(-g)))(
+Do not enter command lines into the history list
+if any command on the line begins with a blank.
+)
+pindex(HIST_NO_FUNCTIONS)
+item(tt(HIST_NO_FUNCTIONS))(
+Do not store function definitions in the history list.
+)
+pindex(HIST_NO_STORE)
+item(tt(HIST_NO_STORE))(
+Remove the tt(history) (tt(fc -l)) command from
+the history when invoked.
+)
+pindex(HIST_REDUCE_BLANKS)
+item(tt(HIST_REDUCE_BLANKS))(
+Remove superfluous blanks from each command line
+being added to the history list.
+)
+pindex(HIST_VERIFY)
+cindex(history, verifying substitution)
+item(tt(HIST_VERIFY))(
+Whenever the user enters a line with history substitution,
+don't execute the line directly; instead, perform
+history substitution and reload the line into the editing buffer.
+)
+pindex(HUP)
+cindex(jobs, HUP)
+item(tt(HUP))(
+Send the tt(HUP) signal to running jobs when the
+shell exits.
+)
+pindex(IGNORE_BRACES)
+cindex(disabling brace expansion)
+cindex(brace expansion, disabling)
+cindex(expansion, brace, disabling)
+item(tt(IGNORE_BRACES) (tt(-I)))(
+Do not perform brace expansion.
+)
+pindex(IGNORE_EOF)
+cindex(EOF, ignoring)
+item(tt(IGNORE_EOF) (tt(-7)))(
+Do not exit on end-of-file.  Require the use
+of tt(exit) or tt(logout) instead.
+However, ten consecutive EOFs will cause the shell to exit anyway,
+to avoid the shell hanging if its tty goes away.
+)
+pindex(INTERACTIVE)
+item(tt(INTERACTIVE) (tt(-i), ksh: tt(-i)))(
+This is an interactive shell.  This option is set upon initialisation if
+the standard input is a tty and commands are being read from standard input.
+(See the discussion of tt(SHIN_STDIN).)
+This heuristic may be overridden by specifying a state for this option
+on the command line.
+The value of this option cannot be changed anywhere other than the command line.
+)
+pindex(INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS)
+cindex(comments, in interactive shells)
+item(tt(INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS) (tt(-k)))(
+Allow comments even in interactive shells.
+)
+pindex(KSH_ARRAYS)
+cindex(arrays, ksh style)
+cindex(array style, ksh)
+cindex(ksh, array style)
+item(tt(KSH_ARRAYS))(
+Emulate bf(ksh) array handling as closely as possible.  If this option
+is set, array elements are numbered from zero, an array parameter
+without subscript refers to the first element instead of the whole array,
+and braces are required to delimit a subscript (`tt(${path[2]})' rather
+than just `tt($path[2])').
+)
+pindex(KSH_AUTOLOAD)
+item(tt(KSH_AUTOLOAD))(
+Emulate bf(ksh) function autoloading.  This means that when a function is
+autoloaded, the corresponding file is merely executed, and must define
+the function itself.  (By default, the function is defined to the contents
+of the file.  However, the most common bf(ksh)-style case - of the file
+containing only a simple definition of the function - is always handled
+in the bf(ksh)-compatible manner.)
+)
+pindex(KSH_GLOB)
+item(tt(KSH_GLOB))(
+In pattern matching, the interpretation of parentheses is affected by
+a preceding `tt(@)', `tt(*)', `tt(+)', `tt(?)' or `tt(!)'.
+See noderef(Filename Generation).
+)
+pindex(KSH_OPTION_PRINT)
+cindex(option printing, ksh style)
+cindex(option printing style, ksh)
+cindex(ksh, option printing style)
+item(tt(KSH_OPTION_PRINT))(
+Alters the way options settings are printed.
+)
+pindex(LIST_AMBIGUOUS)
+cindex(ambiguous completion)
+cindex(completion, ambiguous)
+item(tt(LIST_AMBIGUOUS))(
+If this option is set, completions are shown only if the completions
+don't have a unambiguous prefix or suffix that could be inserted in
+the command line.
+)
+pindex(LIST_BEEP)
+cindex(beep, ambiguous completion)
+cindex(completion, beep on ambiguous)
+item(tt(LIST_BEEP))(
+Beep on an ambiguous completion.
+)
+pindex(LIST_TYPES)
+cindex(marking file types)
+cindex(files, marking type of)
+item(tt(LIST_TYPES) (tt(-X)))(
+When listing files that are possible completions, show the
+type of each file with a trailing identifying mark.
+)
+pindex(LOCAL_OPTIONS)
+item(tt(LOCAL_OPTIONS))(
+If this option is set at the point of return from a shell function,
+all the options (including this one) which were in force upon entry to
+the function are restored.  Otherwise, only this option and the
+tt(XTRACE) and tt(PRINT_EXIT_VALUE) options are restored.  Hence
+if this is explicitly unset by a shell function the other options in
+force at the point of return will remain so.
+A shell function can also guarantee itself a known shell configuration
+with a formulation like `tt(emulate zsh; setopt localoptions)'.
+)
+pindex(LOGIN)
+item(tt(LOGIN) (tt(-l), ksh: tt(-l)))(
+This is a login shell.
+If this option is not explicitly set, the shell is a login shell if
+the first character of the tt(argv[0]) passed to the shell is a `tt(-)'.
+)
+pindex(LONG_LIST_JOBS)
+cindex(jobs, list format)
+item(tt(LONG_LIST_JOBS) (tt(-R)))(
+List jobs in the long format by default.
+)
+pindex(MAGIC_EQUAL_SUBST)
+item(tt(MAGIC_EQUAL_SUBST))(
+All unquoted arguments of the form `var(identifier)tt(=)var(expression)'
+appearing after the command name have filename expansion (that is,
+where var(expression) has a leading `tt(~)' or `tt(=)') performed on
+var(expression) as if it were a parameter assignment.  The argument is
+not otherwise treated specially; it is passed to the command as a single
+argument, and not used as an actual parameter assignment.
+)
+pindex(MAIL_WARNING)
+cindex(mail, warning of reading)
+item(tt(MAIL_WARNING) (tt(-U)))(
+Print a warning message if a mail file has been
+accessed since the shell last checked.
+)
+pindex(MARK_DIRS)
+cindex(directories, marking)
+cindex(marking directories)
+item(tt(MARK_DIRS) (tt(-8), ksh: tt(-X)))(
+Append a trailing `tt(/)' to all directory
+names resulting from filename generation (globbing).
+)
+pindex(MENU_COMPLETE)
+cindex(completion, menu)
+item(tt(MENU_COMPLETE) (tt(-Y)))(
+On an ambiguous completion, instead of listing possibilities or beeping,
+insert the first match immediately.  Then when completion is requested
+again, remove the first match and insert the second match, etc.
+When there are no more matches, go back to the first one again.
+tt(reverse-menu-complete) may be used to loop through the list
+in the other direction. This option overrides tt(AUTO_MENU).
+)
+pindex(MONITOR)
+cindex(job control, allowing)
+item(tt(MONITOR) (tt(-m), ksh: tt(-m)))(
+Allow job control.  Set by default in interactive shells.
+)
+pindex(MULTIOS)
+item(tt(MULTIOS))(
+Perform implicit bf(tee)s or bf(cat)s when multiple
+redirections are attempted (see noderef(Redirection)).
+)
+pindex(NOMATCH)
+cindex(globbing, no matches)
+item(tt(NOMATCH) (tt(PLUS()3)))(
+If a pattern for filename generation has no matches,
+print an error, instead of
+leaving it unchanged in the argument list.
+This also applies to file expansion
+of an initial `tt(~)' or `tt(=)'.
+)
+pindex(NOTIFY)
+cindex(background jobs, notification)
+cindex(notification of background jobs)
+item(tt(NOTIFY) (tt(-5), ksh: tt(-b)))(
+Report the status of background jobs immediately, rather than
+waiting until just before printing a prompt.
+)
+pindex(NULL_GLOB)
+cindex(globbing, no matches)
+item(tt(NULL_GLOB) (tt(-G)))(
+If a pattern for filename generation has no matches,
+delete the pattern from the argument list instead
+of reporting an error.  Overrides tt(NOMATCH).
+)
+pindex(NUMERIC_GLOB_SORT)
+cindex(globbing, sorting numerically)
+item(tt(NUMERIC_GLOB_SORT))(
+If numeric filenames are matched by a filename generation pattern,
+sort the filenames numerically rather than lexicographically.
+)
+pindex(OVERSTRIKE)
+cindex(editor, overstrike mode)
+cindex(overstrike mode, of editor)
+item(tt(OVERSTRIKE))(
+Start up the line editor in overstrike mode.
+)
+pindex(PATH_DIRS)
+cindex(path search, extended)
+item(tt(PATH_DIRS) (tt(-Q)))(
+Perform a path search even on command names with slashes in them.
+Thus if `tt(/usr/local/bin)' is in the user's path, and he types
+`tt(X11/xinit)', the command `tt(/usr/local/bin/X11/xinit)' will be executed
+(assuming it exists).
+Commands explicitly beginning with `tt(/)', `tt(./)' or `tt(../)'
+are not subject to the path search.
+This also applies to the tt(.) builtin,
+and searches for modules performed by the tt(zmodload) builtin.
+)
+pindex(POSIX_BUILTINS)
+item(tt(POSIX_BUILTINS))(
+When this option is set the tt(command) builtin can be used to execute
+shell builtin commands.  Parameter assignments specified before shell
+functions and special builtins are kept after the command completes unless
+the special builtin is prefixed with the tt(command) builtin.  Special
+builtins are
+tt(.),
+tt(:),
+tt(break),
+tt(continue),
+tt(declare),
+tt(eval),
+tt(exit),
+tt(export),
+tt(integer),
+tt(local),
+tt(readonly),
+tt(return),
+tt(set),
+tt(shift),
+tt(source),
+tt(times),
+tt(trap) and
+tt(unset).
+)
+pindex(PRINT_EIGHT_BIT)
+cindex(exit status, printing)
+item(tt(PRINT_EIGHT_BIT))(
+Print eight bit characters literally in completion lists, etc.
+This option is not necessary if your system correctly returns the
+printability of eight bit characters (see manref(ctype)(3)).
+)
+pindex(PRINT_EXIT_VALUE)
+cindex(exit status, printing)
+item(tt(PRINT_EXIT_VALUE) (tt(-1)))(
+Print the exit value of programs with non-zero exit status.
+)
+pindex(PRIVILEGED)
+cindex(privileged mode)
+cindex(mode, privileged)
+item(tt(PRIVILEGED) (tt(-p), ksh: tt(-p)))(
+Turn on privileged mode. This is enabled automatically on startup if the
+effective user (group) ID is not equal to the real user (group) ID.  Turning
+this option off causes the effective user and group IDs to be set to the
+real user and group IDs. This option disables sourcing user startup files.
+If zsh is invoked as `tt(sh)' or `tt(ksh)' with this option set,
+tt(/etc/suid_profile) is sourced (after tt(/etc/profile) on interactive
+shells). Sourcing tt(~/.profile) is disabled and the contents of the
+tt(ENV) variable is ignored. This option cannot be changed using the
+tt(-m) option of tt(setopt) and tt(unsetopt), and changing it inside a
+function always changes it globally regardless of the tt(LOCAL_OPTIONS)
+option.
+)
+pindex(PROMPT_BANG)
+cindex(prompt, ! expansion)
+item(tt(PROMPT_BANG))(
+If set, `tt(!)' is treated specially in prompt expansion.
+See noderef(Prompt Expansion).
+)
+pindex(PROMPT_CR)
+cindex(prompt, with CR)
+item(tt(PROMPT_CR) (tt(PLUS()V)))(
+Print a carriage return just before printing
+a prompt in the line editor.
+)
+pindex(PROMPT_PERCENT)
+cindex(prompt, % expansion)
+item(tt(PROMPT_PERCENT))(
+If set, `tt(%)' is treated specially in prompt expansion.
+See noderef(Prompt Expansion).
+)
+pindex(PROMPT_SUBST)
+cindex(prompt, parameter expansion)
+item(tt(PROMPT_SUBST))(
+If set, em(parameter expansion), em(command substitution) and
+em(arithmetic expansion) are performed in prompts.
+)
+pindex(PUSHD_IGNORE_DUPS)
+cindex(directory stack, ignoring duplicates)
+item(tt(PUSHD_IGNORE_DUPS))(
+Don't push multiple copies of the same directory onto the directory stack.
+)
+pindex(PUSHD_MINUS)
+cindex(directory stack, controlling syntax)
+item(tt(PUSHD_MINUS))(
+Exchanges the meanings of `tt(PLUS())' and `tt(-)'
+when used with a number to specify a directory in the stack.
+)
+pindex(PUSHD_SILENT)
+cindex(directory stack, silencing)
+item(tt(PUSHD_SILENT) (tt(-E)))(
+Do not print the directory stack after tt(pushd) or tt(popd).
+)
+pindex(PUSHD_TO_HOME)
+cindex(pushd, to home)
+item(tt(PUSHD_TO_HOME) (tt(-D)))(
+Have tt(pushd) with no arguments act like `tt(pushd $HOME)'.
+)
+pindex(RC_EXPAND_PARAM)
+cindex(rc, parameter expansion style)
+cindex(parameter expansion style, rc)
+item(tt(RC_EXPAND_PARAM) (tt(-P)))(
+Array expansions of the form
+`var(foo)tt(${)var(xx)tt(})var(bar)', where the parameter
+var(xx) is set to tt(LPAR())var(a b c)tt(RPAR()), are substituted with
+`var(fooabar foobbar foocbar)' instead of the default
+`var(fooa b cbar)'.
+)
+pindex(RC_QUOTES)
+cindex(rc, quoting style)
+cindex(quoting style, rc)
+item(tt(RC_QUOTES))(
+Allow the character sequence `tt('')' to signify a single quote
+within singly quoted strings.
+)
+pindex(RCS)
+cindex(startup files, sourcing)
+item(tt(RCS) (tt(PLUS()f)))(
+After tt(/etc/zshenv) is sourced on startup, source the
+tt(.zshenv), tt(/etc/zprofile), tt(.zprofile),
+tt(/etc/zshrc), tt(.zshrc), tt(/etc/zlogin), tt(.zlogin), and tt(.zlogout)
+files, as described in noderef(Files).
+If this option is unset, only the tt(/etc/zshenv) file is sourced.
+)
+pindex(REC_EXACT)
+cindex(completion, exact matches)
+item(tt(REC_EXACT) (tt(-S)))(
+In completion, recognize exact matches even
+if they are ambiguous.
+)
+pindex(RESTRICTED)
+cindex(restricted shell)
+item(tt(RESTRICTED) (tt(-r)))(
+Enables restricted mode.  This option cannot be changed using
+tt(unsetopt), and setting it inside a function always changes it
+globally regardless of the tt(LOCAL_OPTIONS) option.  See
+noderef(Restricted Shell).
+)
+pindex(RM_STAR_SILENT)
+cindex(rm *, querying before)
+cindex(querying before rm *)
+item(tt(RM_STAR_SILENT) (tt(-H)))(
+Do not query the user before executing `tt(rm *)' or `tt(rm path/*)'.
+)
+pindex(RM_STAR_WAIT)
+cindex(rm *, waiting before)
+cindex(waiting before rm *)
+item(tt(RM_STAR_WAIT))(
+If querying the user before executing `tt(rm *)' or `tt(rm path/*)',
+first wait ten seconds and ignore anything typed in that time.
+This avoids the problem of reflexively answering `yes' to the query
+when one didn't really mean it.  The wait and query can always be
+avoided by expanding the `tt(*)' in ZLE (with tab).
+)
+pindex(SH_FILE_EXPANSION)
+cindex(sh, expansion style)
+cindex(expansion style, sh)
+item(tt(SH_FILE_EXPANSION))(
+Perform filename expansion (e.g., ~ expansion) em(before)
+parameter expansion, command substitution, arithmetic expansion
+and brace expansion.
+If this option is unset, it is performed em(after)
+brace expansion, so things like `tt(~$USERNAME)' and
+`tt(~{pfalstad,rc})' will work.
+)
+pindex(SH_GLOB)
+cindex(sh, globbing style)
+cindex(globbing style, sh)
+item(tt(SH_GLOB))(
+Disables the special meaning of `tt(LPAR())', `tt(|)', `tt(RPAR())'
+and 'tt(<)' for globbing the result of parameter and command substitutions,
+and in some other places where
+the shell accepts patterns.  This option is set by default if zsh is
+invoked as tt(sh) or tt(ksh).
+)
+pindex(SHIN_STDIN)
+item(tt(SHIN_STDIN) (tt(-s), ksh: tt(-s)))(
+Commands are being read from the standard input.
+Commands are read from standard input if no command is specified with
+tt(-c) and no file of commands is specified.  If tt(SHIN_STDIN)
+is set explicitly on the command line,
+any argument that would otherwise have been
+taken as a file to run will instead be treated as a normal positional
+parameter.
+Note that setting or unsetting this option on the command line does not
+necessarily affect the state the option will have while the shell is
+running - that is purely an indicator of whether on not commands are
+em(actually) being read from standard input.
+The value of this option cannot be changed anywhere other than the command line.
+)
+pindex(SH_OPTION_LETTERS)
+cindex(sh, single letter options style)
+cindex(ksh, single letter options style)
+cindex(single letter options, ksh style)
+cindex(options, single letter, ksh style)
+item(tt(SH_OPTION_LETTERS))(
+If this option is set the shell tries to interpret single letter options
+(which are used with tt(set) and tt(setopt)) like bf(ksh) does.
+This also affects the value of the tt(-) special parameter.
+)
+pindex(SHORT_LOOPS)
+item(tt(SHORT_LOOPS))(
+Allow the short forms of tt(for), tt(select),
+tt(if), and tt(function) constructs.
+)
+pindex(SH_WORD_SPLIT)
+cindex(field splitting, sh style)
+cindex(sh, field splitting style)
+item(tt(SH_WORD_SPLIT) (tt(-y)))(
+Causes field splitting to be performed on unquoted parameter expansions.
+Note that this option has nothing to do with word splitting.
+(See noderef(Parameter Expansion).)
+)
+pindex(SINGLE_COMMAND)
+cindex(single command)
+pindex(INTERACTIVE, use of)
+item(tt(SINGLE_COMMAND) (tt(-t), ksh: tt(-t)))(
+If the shell is reading from standard input, it exits after a single command
+has been executed.  This also makes the shell non-interactive, unless the
+tt(INTERACTIVE) option is explicitly set on the command line.
+The value of this option cannot be changed anywhere other than the command line.
+)
+pindex(SINGLE_LINE_ZLE)
+cindex(editor, single line mode)
+item(tt(SINGLE_LINE_ZLE) (tt(-M)))(
+Use single-line command line editing instead of multi-line.
+)
+pindex(SUN_KEYBOARD_HACK)
+cindex(sun keyboard, annoying)
+cindex(annoying keyboard, sun)
+item(tt(SUN_KEYBOARD_HACK) (tt(-L)))(
+If a line ends with a backquote, and there are an odd number
+of backquotes on the line, ignore the trailing backquote.
+This is useful on some keyboards where the return key is
+too small, and the backquote key lies annoyingly close to it.
+)
+pindex(UNSET)
+cindex(parameters, substituting unset)
+cindex(unset parameters, substituting)
+item(tt(UNSET) (tt(PLUS()u), ksh: tt(PLUS()u)))(
+Treat unset parameters as if they were empty when substituting.
+Otherwise they are treated as an error.
+)
+pindex(VERBOSE)
+cindex(tracing, of input lines)
+cindex(input, tracing)
+item(tt(VERBOSE) (tt(-v), ksh: tt(-v)))(
+Print shell input lines as they are read.
+)
+pindex(XTRACE)
+cindex(tracing, of commands)
+cindex(commands, tracing)
+item(tt(XTRACE) (tt(-x), ksh: tt(-x)))(
+Print commands and their arguments as they are executed.
+)
+pindex(ZLE)
+cindex(editor, enabling)
+cindex(enabling the editor)
+item(tt(ZLE) (tt(-Z)))(
+Use the zsh line editor.
+)
+enditem()
+texinode(Option Aliases)(Single Letter Options)(Description of Options)(Options)
+sect(Option Aliases)
+cindex(options, aliases)
+Some options have alternative names.  These aliases are never used for
+output, but can be used just like normal option names when specifying
+options to the shell.
+
+startitem()
+pindex(BRACE_EXPAND)
+item(tt(BRACE_EXPAND))(
+em(NO_)tt(IGNORE_BRACES)
+(ksh and bash compatibility)
+)
+pindex(DOT_GLOB)
+item(tt(DOT_GLOB))(
+tt(GLOB_DOTS)
+(bash compatibility)
+)
+pindex(HASH_ALL)
+item(tt(HASH_ALL))(
+tt(HASH_CMDS)
+(bash compatibility)
+)
+pindex(HIST_APPEND)
+item(tt(HIST_APPEND))(
+tt(APPEND_HISTORY)
+(bash compatibility)
+)
+pindex(HIST_EXPAND)
+item(tt(HIST_EXPAND))(
+tt(BANG_HIST)
+(bash compatibility)
+)
+pindex(LOG)
+item(tt(LOG))(
+em(NO_)tt(HIST_NO_FUNCTIONS)
+(ksh compatibility)
+)
+pindex(MAIL_WARN)
+item(tt(MAIL_WARN))(
+tt(MAIL_WARNING)
+(bash compatibility)
+)
+pindex(ONE_CMD)
+item(tt(ONE_CMD))(
+tt(SINGLE_COMMAND)
+(bash compatibility)
+)
+pindex(PHYSICAL)
+item(tt(PHYSICAL))(
+tt(CHASE_LINKS)
+(ksh and bash compatibility)
+)
+pindex(PROMPT_VARS)
+item(tt(PROMPT_VARS))(
+tt(PROMPT_SUBST)
+(bash compatibility)
+)
+pindex(STDIN)
+item(tt(STDIN))(
+tt(SHIN_STDIN)
+(ksh compatibility)
+)
+pindex(TRACK_ALL)
+item(tt(TRACK_ALL))(
+tt(HASH_CMDS)
+(ksh compatibility)
+)
+enditem()
+texinode(Single Letter Options)()(Option Aliases)(Options)
+sect(Single Letter Options)
+cindex(options, single letter)
+cindex(single letter options)
+subsect(Default set)
+startsitem()
+sitem(tt(-0))(CORRECT)
+sitem(tt(-1))(PRINT_EXIT_VALUE)
+sitem(tt(-2))(em(NO_)BAD_PATTERN)
+sitem(tt(-3))(em(NO_)NOMATCH)
+sitem(tt(-4))(GLOB_DOTS)
+sitem(tt(-5))(NOTIFY)
+sitem(tt(-6))(BG_NICE)
+sitem(tt(-7))(IGNORE_EOF)
+sitem(tt(-8))(MARK_DIRS)
+sitem(tt(-9))(AUTO_LIST)
+sitem(tt(-B))(em(NO_)BEEP)
+sitem(tt(-C))(em(NO_)CLOBBER)
+sitem(tt(-D))(PUSHD_TO_HOME)
+sitem(tt(-E))(PUSHD_SILENT)
+sitem(tt(-F))(em(NO_)GLOB)
+sitem(tt(-G))(NULL_GLOB)
+sitem(tt(-H))(RM_STAR_SILENT)
+sitem(tt(-I))(IGNORE_BRACES)
+sitem(tt(-J))(AUTO_CD)
+sitem(tt(-K))(em(NO_)BANG_HIST)
+sitem(tt(-L))(SUN_KEYBOARD_HACK)
+sitem(tt(-M))(SINGLE_LINE_ZLE)
+sitem(tt(-N))(AUTO_PUSHD)
+sitem(tt(-O))(CORRECT_ALL)
+sitem(tt(-P))(RC_EXPAND_PARAM)
+sitem(tt(-Q))(PATH_DIRS)
+sitem(tt(-R))(LONG_LIST_JOBS)
+sitem(tt(-S))(REC_EXACT)
+sitem(tt(-T))(CDABLE_VARS)
+sitem(tt(-U))(MAIL_WARNING)
+sitem(tt(-V))(em(NO_)PROMPT_CR)
+sitem(tt(-W))(AUTO_RESUME)
+sitem(tt(-X))(LIST_TYPES)
+sitem(tt(-Y))(MENU_COMPLETE)
+sitem(tt(-Z))(ZLE)
+sitem(tt(-a))(ALL_EXPORT)
+sitem(tt(-e))(ERR_EXIT)
+sitem(tt(-f))(em(NO_)RCS)
+sitem(tt(-g))(HIST_IGNORE_SPACE)
+sitem(tt(-h))(HIST_IGNORE_DUPS)
+sitem(tt(-i))(INTERACTIVE)
+sitem(tt(-k))(INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS)
+sitem(tt(-l))(LOGIN)
+sitem(tt(-m))(MONITOR)
+sitem(tt(-n))(em(NO_)EXEC)
+sitem(tt(-p))(PRIVILEGED)
+sitem(tt(-r))(RESTRICTED)
+sitem(tt(-s))(SHIN_STDIN)
+sitem(tt(-t))(SINGLE_COMMAND)
+sitem(tt(-u))(em(NO_)UNSET)
+sitem(tt(-v))(VERBOSE)
+sitem(tt(-w))(CHASE_LINKS)
+sitem(tt(-x))(XTRACE)
+sitem(tt(-y))(SH_WORD_SPLIT)
+endsitem()
+subsect(sh/ksh emulation set)
+startsitem()
+sitem(tt(-C))(em(NO_)CLOBBER)
+sitem(tt(-X))(MARK_DIRS)
+sitem(tt(-a))(ALL_EXPORT)
+sitem(tt(-b))(NOTIFY)
+sitem(tt(-e))(ERR_EXIT)
+sitem(tt(-f))(em(NO_)GLOB)
+sitem(tt(-i))(INTERACTIVE)
+sitem(tt(-l))(LOGIN)
+sitem(tt(-m))(MONITOR)
+sitem(tt(-n))(em(NO_)EXEC)
+sitem(tt(-p))(PRIVILEGED)
+sitem(tt(-r))(RESTRICTED)
+sitem(tt(-s))(SHIN_STDIN)
+sitem(tt(-t))(SINGLE_COMMAND)
+sitem(tt(-u))(em(NO_)UNSET)
+sitem(tt(-v))(VERBOSE)
+sitem(tt(-x))(XTRACE)
+endsitem()
+subsect(Also note)
+startsitem()
+sitem(tt(-A))(Used by tt(set) for setting arrays)
+sitem(tt(-c))(Used on the command line to specify a single command)
+sitem(tt(-m))(Used by tt(setopt) for pattern-matching option setting)
+sitem(tt(-o))(Used in all places to allow use of long option names)
+sitem(tt(-s))(Used by tt(set) to sort positional parameters)
+endsitem()
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/params.yo b/Doc/Zsh/params.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..4c25a18ef
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/params.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,812 @@
+texinode(Parameters)(Options)(Expansion)(Top)
+chapter(Parameters)
+cindex(parameters)
+sect(Description)
+A parameter has a name, a value, and a number of attributes.
+A name may be any sequence of alphanumeric
+characters and underscores, or the single characters
+`tt(*)', `tt(@)', `tt(#)', `tt(?)', `tt(-)', `tt($)', or `tt(!)'.
+The value may be a em(scalar) (a string),
+an integer, or an array.
+To assign a scalar or integer value to a parameter,
+use the tt(typeset) builtin.
+findex(typeset, use of)
+To assign an array value, use `tt(set -A) var(name) var(value) ...'.
+findex(set, use of)
+The value of a parameter may also be assigned by writing:
+
+nofill(var(name)tt(=)var(value))
+
+If the integer attribute, tt(-i), is set for var(name),
+the var(value) is subject to arithmetic evaluation.
+
+In the parameter lists, the mark `<S>' indicates that the parameter is special.
+Special parameters cannot have their type changed, and they stay special even
+if unset.  `<Z>' indicates that the parameter does not exist when the shell
+initialises in tt(sh) or tt(ksh) emulation mode.
+startmenu()
+menu(Local Parameters)
+menu(Array Parameters)
+menu(Positional Parameters)
+menu(Parameters Set By The Shell)
+menu(Parameters Used By The Shell)
+endmenu()
+texinode(Local Parameters)(Array Parameters)()(Parameters)
+sect(Local Parameters)
+Shell function executions delimit scopes for shell parameters.
+(Parameters are dynamically scoped.)  The tt(typeset) builtin, and its
+alternative forms tt(declare), tt(integer), tt(local) and tt(readonly)
+(but not tt(export)), can be used to declare a parameter as being local
+to the innermost scope.
+
+When a parameter is read or assigned to, the
+innermost existing parameter of that name is used.  (That is, the
+local parameter hides any less-local parameter.)  However, assigning
+to a non-existent parameter, or declaring a new parameter with tt(export),
+causes it to be created in the em(outer)most scope.
+
+Local parameters disappear when their scope ends.
+tt(unset) can be used to delete a parameter while it is still in scope; this
+will reveal the next outer parameter of the same name.  However, em(special)
+parameters are still special when unset.
+texinode(Array Parameters)(Positional Parameters)(Local Parameters)(Parameters)
+sect(Array Parameters)
+The value of an array parameter may be assigned by writing:
+
+nofill(var(name)tt(=LPAR())var(value) ...tt(RPAR()))
+
+Individual elements of an array may be selected using a
+subscript.  A subscript of the form `tt([)var(exp)tt(])'
+selects the single element var(exp), where var(exp) is
+an arithmetic expression which will be subject to arithmetic
+expansion as if it were surrounded by `tt($LPAR()LPAR())...tt(RPAR()RPAR())'.
+The elements are numbered beginning with 1 unless the
+tt(KSH_ARRAYS) option is set when they are numbered from zero.
+pindex(KSH_ARRAYS, use of)
+
+A subscript of the form `tt([*])' or `tt([@])' evaluates to all
+elements of an array; there is no difference between the two
+except when they appear within double quotes.
+`tt("$foo[*]")' evaluates to `tt("$foo[1] $foo[2] )...tt(")', while
+`tt("$foo[@]")' evaluates to `tt("$foo[1]" "$foo[2]")', etc.
+
+A subscript of the form `tt([)var(exp1)tt(,)var(exp2)tt(])'
+selects all elements in the range var(exp1) to var(exp2),
+inclusive.
+If one of the subscripts evaluates to a negative number,
+say tt(-)var(n), then the var(n)th element from the end
+of the array is used.  Thus `tt($foo[-3])' is the third element
+from the end of the array tt(foo), and
+`tt($foo[1,-1])' is the same as `tt($foo[*])'.
+
+Subscripting may also be performed on non-array values, in which
+case the subscripts specify a substring to be extracted.
+For example, if tt(FOO) is set to `tt(foobar)', then
+`tt(echo $FOO[2,5])' prints `tt(ooba)'.
+
+Subscripts may be used inside braces used to delimit a parameter name, thus
+`tt(${foo[2]})' is equivalent to `tt($foo[2])'.  If the tt(KSH_ARRAYS)
+option is set, the braced form is the only one that will
+work, the subscript otherwise not being treated specially.
+
+If a subscript is used on the left side of an assignment the selected
+range is replaced by the expression on the right side.
+
+If the opening bracket or the comma is directly followed by an opening
+parentheses the string up to the matching closing one is considered to
+be a list of flags. The flags currently understood are:
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(e))(
+this option has no effect and retained for backward compatibility only.
+)
+item(tt(w))(
+if the parameter subscripted is a scalar than this flag makes
+subscription work on a per-word basis instead of characters.
+)
+item(tt(s:)var(string)tt(:))(
+this gives the var(string) that separates words (for use with the
+tt(w) flag).
+)
+item(tt(p))(
+Recognize the same escape sequences as the tt(print) builtin in
+the string argument of a subsequent `tt(s)' flag.
+)
+item(tt(f))(
+if the parameter subscripted is a scalar than this flag makes
+subscription work on a per-line basis instead of characters.
+This is a shorthand for `tt(pws:\n:)'.
+)
+item(tt(r))(
+if this flag is given the var(exp) is taken as a pattern and the
+result is the first matching array element, substring or word (if the
+parameter is an array, if it is a scalar, or if it is a scalar and the
+`tt(w)' flag is given, respectively); note that this is like giving a
+number: `tt($foo[(r))var(??)tt(,3])' and `tt($foo[(r))var(??)tt(,(r)f*])' work.
+)
+item(tt(R))(
+like `tt(r)', but gives the last match.
+)
+item(tt(i))(
+like `tt(r)', but gives the index of the match instead; this may not
+be combined with a second argument.
+)
+item(tt(I))(
+like `tt(i), but gives the index of the last match.
+)
+item(tt(n:)var(expr)tt(:))(
+if combined with `tt(r)', `tt(R)', `tt(i)' or `tt(I)', makes them give
+the var(n)th or var(n)th last match (if var(expr) evaluates to
+var(n)).
+)
+enditem()
+texinode(Positional Parameters)(Parameters Set By The Shell)(Array Parameters)(Parameters)
+sect(Positional Parameters)
+Positional parameters are set by the shell on invocation,
+by the tt(set) builtin, or by direct assignment.
+The parameter var(n), where var(n) is a number,
+is the var(n)th positional parameter.
+The parameters tt(*), tt(@) and tt(argv) are
+arrays containing all the positional parameters;
+thus `tt($argv[)var(n)tt(])', etc., is equivalent to simply `tt($)var(n)'.
+
+texinode(Parameters Set By The Shell)(Parameters Used By The Shell)(Positional Parameters)(Parameters)
+sect(Parameters Set By The Shell)
+The following parameters are automatically set by the shell:
+
+startitem()
+vindex(!)
+item(tt(!) <S>)(
+The process ID of the last background command invoked.
+)
+vindex(#)
+item(tt(#) <S>)(
+The number of positional parameters in decimal.
+)
+vindex(ARGC)
+item(tt(ARGC) <S> <Z>)(
+Same as tt(#).
+)
+vindex($)
+item(tt($) <S>)(
+The process ID of this shell.
+)
+vindex(-)
+item(tt(-) <S>)(
+Flags supplied to the shell on invocation or by the tt(set)
+or tt(setopt) commands.
+)
+vindex(*)
+item(tt(*) <S>)(
+An array containing the positional parameters.
+)
+vindex(argv)
+item(tt(argv) <S> <Z>)(
+Same as tt(*).
+)
+vindex(@)
+item(tt(@) <S>)(
+Same as tt(argv[@]).
+)
+vindex(?)
+item(tt(?) <S>)(
+The exit value returned by the last command.
+)
+vindex(0)
+item(tt(0) <S>)(
+The name used to invoke the current shell.  If the tt(FUNCTION_ARGZERO) option
+is set, this is set temporarily within a shell function to the name of the
+function, and within a sourced script to the name of the script.
+)
+vindex(status)
+item(tt(status) <S> <Z>)(
+Same as tt(?).
+)
+vindex(_)
+item(tt(_) <S>)(
+The last argument of the previous command.
+Also, this parameter is set in the environment of every command
+executed to the full pathname of the command.
+)
+vindex(EGID)
+item(tt(EGID) <S>)(
+The effective group ID of the shell process.  If you have sufficient
+privileges, you may change the effective group ID of the shell
+process by assigning to this parameter.  Also (assuming sufficient
+privileges), you may start a single command with a different
+effective group ID by `tt(LPAR()EGID=)var(gid)tt(; command+RPAR())'
+)
+vindex(EUID)
+item(tt(EUID) <S>)(
+The effective user ID of the shell process.  If you have sufficient
+privileges, you may change the effective user ID of the shell process
+by assigning to this parameter.  Also (assuming sufficient privileges),
+you may start a single command with a different
+effective user ID by `tt(LPAR()EUID=)var(uid)tt(; command+RPAR())'
+)
+vindex(ERRNO)
+item(tt(ERRNO) <S>)(
+The value of errno (see manref(errno)(3))
+as set by the most recently failed system call.
+This value is system dependent and is intended for debugging
+purposes.
+)
+vindex(GID)
+item(tt(GID) <S>)(
+The real group ID of the shell process.  If you have sufficient privileges,
+you may change the group ID of the shell process by assigning to this
+parameter.  Also (assuming sufficient privileges), you may start a single
+command under a different
+group ID by `tt(LPAR()GID=)var(gid)tt(; command+RPAR())'
+)
+vindex(HOST)
+item(tt(HOST))(
+The current hostname.
+)
+vindex(LINENO)
+item(tt(LINENO) <S>)(
+The line number of the current line within the current script
+being executed.
+)
+vindex(LOGNAME)
+item(tt(LOGNAME))(
+If the corresponding variable is not set in the environment of the
+shell, it is initialized to the login name corresponding to the
+current login session. This parameter is exported by default but
+this can be disabled using the tt(typeset) builtin.
+)
+vindex(MACHTYPE)
+item(tt(MACHTYPE))(
+The machine type (microprocessor class or machine model),
+as determined at compile time.
+)
+vindex(OLDPWD)
+item(tt(OLDPWD))(
+The previous working directory.  This is set when the shell initialises
+and whenever the directory changes.
+)
+vindex(OPTARG)
+item(tt(OPTARG) <S>)(
+The value of the last option argument processed by the tt(getopts)
+command.
+)
+vindex(OPTIND)
+item(tt(OPTIND) <S>)(
+The index of the last option argument processed by the tt(getopts)
+command.
+)
+vindex(OSTYPE)
+item(tt(OSTYPE))(
+The operating system, as determined at compile time.
+)
+vindex(PPID)
+item(tt(PPID) <S>)(
+The process ID of the parent of the shell.
+)
+vindex(PWD)
+item(tt(PWD))(
+The present working directory.  This is set when the shell initialises
+and whenever the directory changes.
+)
+vindex(RANDOM)
+item(tt(RANDOM) <S>)(
+A random integer from 0 to 32767, newly generated each time
+this parameter is referenced.  The random number generator
+can be seeded by assigning a numeric value to tt(RANDOM).
+)
+vindex(SECONDS)
+item(tt(SECONDS) <S>)(
+The number of seconds since shell invocation.  If this parameter
+is assigned a value, then the value returned upon reference
+will be the value that was assigned plus the number of seconds
+since the assignment.
+)
+vindex(SHLVL)
+item(tt(SHLVL) <S>)(
+Incremented by one each time a new shell is started.
+)
+vindex(signals)
+item(tt(signals))(
+An array containing the names of the signals.
+)
+vindex(TTY)
+item(tt(TTY))(
+The name of the tty associated with the shell, if any.
+)
+vindex(TTYIDLE)
+item(tt(TTYIDLE) <S>)(
+The idle time of the tty associated with the shell in seconds or -1 if there
+is no such tty.
+)
+vindex(UID)
+item(tt(UID) <S>)(
+The real user ID of the shell process.  If you have sufficient privileges,
+you may change the user ID of the shell by assigning to this parameter.
+Also (assuming sufficient privileges), you may start a single command
+under a different
+user ID by `tt(LPAR()UID=)var(uid)tt(; command+RPAR())'
+)
+vindex(USERNAME)
+item(tt(USERNAME) <S>)(
+The username corresponding to the real user ID of the shell process.  If you
+have sufficient privileges, you may change the username (and also the
+user ID and group ID) of the shell by assigning to this parameter.
+Also (assuming sufficient privileges), you may start a single command
+under a different username (and user ID and group ID)
+by `tt(LPAR()USERNAME=)var(username)tt(; command+RPAR())'
+)
+vindex(VENDOR)
+item(tt(VENDOR))(
+The vendor, as determined at compile time.
+)
+vindex(ZSH_NAME)
+item(tt(ZSH_NAME))(
+Expands to the basename of the command used to invoke this instance
+of zsh.
+)
+vindex(ZSH_VERSION)
+item(tt(ZSH_VERSION))(
+The version number of this zsh.
+)
+enditem()
+texinode(Parameters Used By The Shell)()(Parameters Set By The Shell)(Parameters)
+sect(Parameters Used By The Shell)
+The following parameters are used by the shell:
+
+startitem()
+vindex(ARGV0)
+item(tt(ARGV0))(
+If exported, its value is used as tt(argv[0]) of external commands.
+Usually used in constructs like `tt(ARGV0=emacs nethack)'.
+)
+vindex(BAUD)
+item(tt(BAUD))(
+The baud rate of the current connection.  Used by the line editor
+update mechanism to compensate for a slow terminal by delaying
+updates until necessary.  This may be profitably set to a lower value
+in some circumstances, e.g.
+for slow modems dialing into a communications server which is connected
+to a host via a fast link; in this case, this variable
+would be set by default to the speed of the fast link, and not
+the modem.
+This parameter should be set to the baud
+rate of the slowest part of the link for best performance. The compensation
+mechanism can be turned off by setting the variable to zero.
+)
+vindex(cdpath)
+vindex(CDPATH)
+item(tt(cdpath) <S> <Z> (tt(CDPATH) <S>))(
+An array (colon-separated list)
+of directories specifying the search path for the tt(cd) command.
+)
+vindex(COLUMNS)
+item(tt(COLUMNS) <S>)(
+The number of columns for this terminal session.
+Used for printing select lists and for the line editor.
+)
+vindex(DIRSTACKSIZE)
+item(tt(DIRSTACKSIZE))(
+The maximum size of the directory stack.  If the
+stack gets larger than this, it will be truncated automatically.
+This is useful with the tt(AUTO_PUSHD) option.
+pindex(AUTO_PUSHD, use of)
+)
+vindex(FCEDIT)
+item(tt(FCEDIT))(
+The default editor for the tt(fc) builtin.
+)
+vindex(fignore)
+vindex(FIGNORE)
+item(tt(fignore) <S> <Z> (tt(FIGNORE) <S>))(
+An array (colon separated list)
+containing the suffixes of files to be ignored
+during filename completion.  However, if the completion generates only files
+which would match if this variable would be ignored, than these files are
+completed anyway.
+)
+vindex(fpath)
+vindex(FPATH)
+item(tt(fpath) <S> <Z> (tt(FPATH) <S>))(
+An array (colon separated list)
+of directories specifying the search path for
+function definitions.  This path is searched when a function
+with the tt(-u) attribute is referenced.  If an executable
+file is found, then it is read and executed in the current environment.
+)
+vindex(histchars)
+item(tt(histchars) <S>)(
+Three characters used by the shell's history and lexical analysis
+mechanism.  The first character signals the start of a history
+substitution (default `tt(!)').  The second character signals the
+start of a quick history substitution (default `tt(^)').  The third
+character is the comment character (default `tt(#)').
+)
+vindex(HISTCHARS)
+item(tt(HISTCHARS) <S> <Z>)(
+Same as tt(histchars).  (Deprecated.)
+)
+vindex(HISTFILE)
+item(tt(HISTFILE))(
+The file to save the history in when an interactive shell exits.
+If unset, the history is not saved.
+)
+vindex(HISTSIZE)
+item(tt(HISTSIZE) <S>)(
+The maximum size of the history list.
+)
+vindex(HOME)
+item(tt(HOME) <S>)(
+The default argument for the tt(cd) command.
+)
+vindex(IFS)
+item(tt(IFS) <S>)(
+Internal field separators (by default space, tab, newline and NUL), that
+are used to separate words which result from
+command or parameter substitution and words read by
+the tt(read) builtin.  Any characters from the set space, tab and
+newline that appear in the IFS are called em(IFS white space).
+One or more IFS white space characters or one non-IFS white space
+character together with any adjacent IFS white space character delimit
+a field.  If an IFS white space character appears twice consecutively
+in the IFS, this character is treated as if it were not an IFS white
+space character.
+)
+vindex(KEYTIMEOUT)
+item(tt(KEYTIMEOUT))(
+The time the shell waits, in hundredths of seconds, for another key to
+be pressed when reading bound multi-character sequences.
+)
+vindex(LANG)
+item(tt(LANG) <S>)(
+This variable determines the locale category for any category not
+specifically selected via a variable starting with `tt(LC_)'.
+)
+vindex(LC_ALL)
+item(tt(LC_ALL) <S>)(
+This variable overrides the value of the `tt(LANG)' variable and the value
+of any of the other variables starting with `tt(LC_)'.
+)
+vindex(LC_COLLATE)
+item(tt(LC_COLLATE) <S>)(
+This variable determines the locale category for character collation
+information within ranges in glob brackets and for sorting.
+)
+vindex(LC_CTYPE)
+item(tt(LC_CTYPE) <S>)(
+This variable determines the locale category for character handling
+functions.
+)
+vindex(LC_MESSAGES)
+item(tt(LC_MESSAGES) <S>)(
+This variable determines the language in which messages should be
+written.  Note that zsh does not use message catalogs.
+)
+vindex(LC_TIME)
+item(tt(LC_TIME) <S>)(
+This variable determines the locale category for date and time
+formatting in prompt escape sequences.
+)
+vindex(LINES)
+item(tt(LINES) <S>)(
+The number of lines for this terminal session.
+Used for printing select lists and for the line editor.
+)
+vindex(LISTMAX)
+item(tt(LISTMAX))(
+In the line editor, the number of filenames to list without asking first.
+If set to zero, the shell asks only if the top of the listing would scroll
+off the screen.
+)
+vindex(LOGCHECK)
+item(tt(LOGCHECK))(
+The interval in seconds between checks for login/logout activity
+using the tt(watch) parameter.
+)
+vindex(MAIL)
+item(tt(MAIL))(
+If this parameter is set and tt(mailpath) is not set,
+the shell looks for mail in the specified file.
+)
+vindex(MAILCHECK)
+item(tt(MAILCHECK))(
+The interval in seconds between checks for new mail.
+)
+vindex(mailpath)
+vindex(MAILPATH)
+item(tt(mailpath) <S> <Z> (tt(MAILPATH) <S>))(
+An array (colon-separated list) of filenames to check for
+new mail.  Each filename can be followed by a `tt(?)' and a
+message that will be printed.  The message will undergo
+parameter expansion, command substitution and arithmetic
+substitution with the variable tt($_) defined as the name
+of the file that has changed.  The default message is
+`tt(You have new mail)'.  If an element is a directory
+instead of a file the shell will recursively check every
+file in every subdirectory of the element.
+)
+vindex(manpath)
+vindex(MANPATH)
+item(tt(manpath) <S> <Z> (tt(MANPATH) <S> <Z>))(
+An array (colon-separated list)
+whose value is not used by the shell.  The tt(manpath)
+array can be useful, however, since setting it also sets
+tt(MANPATH), and vice versa.
+)
+vindex(module_path)
+vindex(MODULE_PATH)
+item(tt(module_path) <S> <Z> (tt(MODULE_PATH) <S>))(
+An array (colon-separated list)
+of directories that tt(zmodload)
+searches for dynamically loadable modules.
+This is initialised to a standard pathname,
+usually `tt(/usr/local/lib/zsh/$ZSH_VERSION)'.
+(The `tt(/usr/local/lib)' part varies from installation to installation.)
+For security reasons, any value set in the environment when the shell
+is started will be ignored.
+
+These parameters only exist if the installation supports dynamic
+module loading.
+)
+vindex(NULLCMD)
+cindex(null command style)
+cindex(csh, null command style)
+cindex(ksh, null command style)
+item(tt(NULLCMD) <S>)(
+The command name to assume if a redirection is specified
+with no command.  Defaults to tt(cat).  For bf(sh)/bf(ksh)
+behavior, change this to tt(:).  For bf(csh)-like
+behavior, unset this parameter; the shell will print an
+error message if null commands are entered.
+)
+vindex(path)
+vindex(PATH)
+item(tt(path) <S> <Z> (tt(PATH) <S>))(
+An array (colon-separated list)
+of directories to search for commands.
+When this parameter is set, each directory is scanned
+and all files found are put in a hash table.
+)
+vindex(POSTEDIT)
+item(tt(POSTEDIT) <S>)(
+This string is output whenever the line editor exits.
+It usually contains termcap strings to reset the terminal.
+)
+vindex(PS1)
+item(tt(PS1) <S>)(
+The primary prompt string, printed before a command is read.
+the default is `tt(%m%# )'.  It undergoes a special form of expansion
+before being displayed; see noderef(Prompt Expansion).
+)
+vindex(PS2)
+item(tt(PS2) <S>)(
+The secondary prompt, printed when the shell needs more information
+to complete a command.
+It is expanded in the same way as tt(PS1).
+The default is `tt(%_> )', which displays any shell constructs or quotation
+marks which are currently being processed.
+)
+vindex(PS3)
+item(tt(PS3) <S>)(
+Selection prompt used within a tt(select) loop.
+It is expanded in the same way as tt(PS1).
+The default is `tt(?# )'.
+)
+vindex(PS4)
+item(tt(PS4) <S>)(
+The execution trace prompt.  Default is `tt(PLUS() )'.
+)
+vindex(PROMPT)
+xitem(tt(PROMPT) <S> <Z>)
+vindex(PROMPT2)
+xitem(tt(PROMPT2) <S> <Z>)
+vindex(PROMPT3)
+xitem(tt(PROMPT3) <S> <Z>)
+vindex(PROMPT4)
+item(tt(PROMPT4) <S> <Z>)(
+Same as tt(PS1), tt(PS2), tt(PS3) and tt(PS4),
+respectively.
+)
+vindex(psvar)
+vindex(PSVAR)
+item(tt(psvar) <S> <Z> (tt(PSVAR) <S>))(
+An array (colon-separated list) whose first nine values can be used in
+tt(PROMPT) strings.  Setting tt(psvar) also sets tt(PSVAR), and
+vice versa.
+)
+vindex(prompt)
+item(tt(prompt) <S> <Z>)(
+Same as tt(PS1).
+)
+vindex(READNULLCMD)
+item(tt(READNULLCMD) <S>)(
+The command name to assume if a single input redirection
+is specified with no command.  Defaults to tt(more).
+)
+vindex(REPORTTIME)
+item(tt(REPORTTIME))(
+If nonnegative, commands whose combined user and system execution times
+(measured in seconds) are greater than this value have timing
+statistics printed for them.
+)
+vindex(RPROMPT)
+xitem(tt(RPROMPT) <S>)
+vindex(RPS1)
+item(tt(RPS1) <S>)(
+This prompt is displayed on the right-hand side of the screen
+when the primary prompt is being displayed on the left.
+This does not work if the tt(SINGLELINEZLE) option is set.
+It is expanded in the same way as tt(PS1).
+)
+vindex(SAVEHIST)
+item(tt(SAVEHIST))(
+The maximum number of history events to save in the history file.
+)
+vindex(SPROMPT)
+item(tt(SPROMPT) <S>)(
+The prompt used for spelling correction.  The sequence
+`tt(%R)' expands to the string which presumably needs spelling
+correction, and `tt(%r)' expands to the proposed correction.
+All other prompt escapes are also allowed.
+)
+vindex(STTY)
+item(tt(STTY))(
+If this parameter is set in a command's environment, the shell runs the
+tt(stty) command with the value of this parameter as arguments in order to
+set up the terminal before executing the command. The modes apply only to the
+command, and are reset when it finishes or is suspended. If the command is
+suspended and continued later with the tt(fg) or tt(wait) builtins it will
+see the modes specified by tt(STTY), as if it were not suspended.  This
+(intentionally) does not apply if the command is continued via `tt(kill -CONT)'.
+tt(STTY) is ignored if the command is run in the background, or if it is in the
+environment of the shell but not explicitly assigned to in the input line. This
+avoids running stty at every external command by accidentally exporting it.
+Also note that tt(STTY) should not be used for window size specifications; these
+will not be local to the command.
+)
+vindex(TERM)
+item(tt(TERM) <S>)(
+The type of terminal in use.  This is used when looking up termcap sequences.
+)
+vindex(TIMEFMT)
+item(tt(TIMEFMT))(
+The format of process time reports with the tt(time) keyword.
+The default is `tt(%E real  %U user  %S system  %P %J)'.
+Recognizes the following escape sequences:
+
+startsitem()
+sitem(tt(%%))(A `tt(%)'.)
+sitem(tt(%U))(CPU seconds spent in user mode.)
+sitem(tt(%S))(CPU seconds spent in kernel mode.)
+sitem(tt(%E))(Elapsed time in seconds.)
+sitem(tt(%P))(The CPU percentage, computed as (tt(%U)PLUS()tt(%S))/tt(%E).)
+sitem(tt(%J))(The name of this job.)
+endsitem()
+
+A star may be inserted between the percent sign and flags printing time.
+This cause the time to be printed in
+`var(hh)tt(:)var(mm)tt(:)var(ss)tt(.)var(ttt)'
+format (hours and minutes are only printed if they are not zero).
+)
+vindex(TMOUT)
+item(tt(TMOUT))(
+If this parameter is nonzero, the shell will receive an tt(ALRM)
+signal if a command is not entered within the specified number of
+seconds after issuing a prompt. If there is a trap on tt(SIGALRM), it
+will be executed and a new alarm is scheduled using the value of the
+tt(TMOUT) parameter after executing the trap.  If no trap is set, and
+the idle time of the terminal is not less than the value of the
+tt(TMOUT) parameter, zsh terminates.  Otherwise a new alarm is
+scheduled to tt(TMOUT) seconds after the last keypress.
+)
+vindex(TMPPREFIX)
+item(tt(TMPPREFIX))(
+A pathname prefix which the shell will use for all temporary files.
+Note that this should include an initial part for the file name as
+well as any directory names.  The default is `tt(/tmp/zsh)'.
+)
+vindex(watch)
+vindex(WATCH)
+item(tt(watch) <S> <Z> (tt(WATCH) <S>))(
+An array (colon-separated list) of login/logout events to report.
+If it contains the single word `tt(all)', then all login/logout events
+are reported.  If it contains the single word `tt(notme)', then all
+events are reported as with `tt(all)' except tt($USERNAME).
+An entry in this list may consist of a username,
+an `tt(@)' followed by a remote hostname,
+and a `tt(%)' followed by a line (tty).
+Any or all of these components may be present in an entry;
+if a login/logout event matches all of them,
+it is reported.
+)
+vindex(WATCHFMT)
+item(tt(WATCHFMT))(
+The format of login/logout reports if the tt(watch) parameter is set.
+Default is `tt(%n has %a %l from %m)'.
+Recognizes the following escape sequences:
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(%n))(
+The name of the user that logged in/out.
+)
+item(tt(%a))(
+The observed action, i.e. "logged on" or "logged off".
+)
+item(tt(%l))(
+The line (tty) the user is logged in on.
+)
+item(tt(%M))(
+The full hostname of the remote host.
+)
+item(tt(%m))(
+The hostname up to the first `tt(.)'.  If only the
+IP address is available or the utmp field contains
+the name of an X-windows display, the whole name is printed.
+
+em(NOTE:)
+The `tt(%m)' and `tt(%M)' escapes will work only if there is a host name
+field in the utmp on your machine.  Otherwise they are
+treated as ordinary strings.
+)
+item(tt(%S) LPAR()tt(%s)RPAR())(
+Start (stop) standout mode.
+)
+item(tt(%U) LPAR()tt(%u)RPAR())(
+Start (stop) underline mode.
+)
+item(tt(%B) LPAR()tt(%b)RPAR())(
+Start (stop) boldface mode.
+)
+xitem(tt(%t))
+item(tt(%@))(
+The time, in 12-hour, am/pm format.
+)
+item(tt(%T))(
+The time, in 24-hour format.
+)
+item(tt(%w))(
+The date in `var(day)tt(-)var(dd)' format.
+)
+item(tt(%W))(
+The date in `var(mm)tt(/)var(dd)tt(/)var(yy)' format.
+)
+item(tt(%D))(
+The date in `var(yy)tt(-)var(mm)tt(-)var(dd)' format.
+)
+item(tt(%LPAR())var(x)tt(:)var(true-text)tt(:)var(false-text)tt(RPAR()))(
+Specifies a ternary expression.
+The character following the var(x) is
+arbitrary; the same character is used to separate the text
+for the "true" result from that for the "false" result.
+Both the separator and the right parenthesis may be escaped
+with a backslash.
+Ternary expressions may be nested.
+
+The test character var(x) may be any one of `tt(l)', `tt(n)', `tt(m)'
+or `tt(M)', which indicate a `true' result if the corresponding
+escape sequence would return a non-empty value; or it may be `tt(a)',
+which indicates a `true' result if the watched user has logged in,
+or `false' if he has logged out.
+Other characters evaluate to neither true nor false; the entire
+expression is omitted in this case.
+
+If the result is `true', then the var(true-text)
+is formatted according to the rules above and printed,
+and the var(false-text) is skipped.
+If `false', the var(true-text) is skipped and the var(false-text)
+is formatted and printed.
+Either or both of the branches may be empty, but
+both separators must be present in any case.
+)
+enditem()
+)
+vindex(WORDCHARS)
+item(tt(WORDCHARS) <S>)(
+A list of non-alphanumeric characters considered part of a word
+by the line editor.
+)
+vindex(ZDOTDIR)
+item(tt(ZDOTDIR))(
+The directory to search for shell startup files (.zshrc, etc),
+if not tt($HOME).
+)
+enditem()
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/prompt.yo b/Doc/Zsh/prompt.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..e1628da86
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/prompt.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,209 @@
+texinode(Prompt Expansion)(Restricted Shell)(Compatibility)(Top)
+chapter(Prompt Expansion)
+ifzman(\
+sect(Prompt Expansion)
+)\
+Prompt sequences undergo a special form of expansion.  This type of expansion
+is also available using the tt(-P) option to the tt(print) builtin.
+
+pindex(PROMPT_SUBST, use of)
+If the tt(PROMPT_SUBST) option is set, the prompt string is first subjected to
+em(parameter expansion),
+em(command substitution) and
+em(arithmetic expansion).
+See
+ifzman(\
+zmanref(zshexpn).
+)\
+ifnzman(\
+noderef(Expansion).
+)\
+
+Certain escape sequences may be recognised in the prompt string.
+
+pindex(PROMPT_BANG, use of)
+If the tt(PROMPT_BANG) option is set, a `tt(!)' in the prompt is replaced
+by the current history event number.  A literal `tt(!)' may then be
+represented as `tt(!!)'.
+
+pindex(PROMPT_PERCENT, use of)
+If the tt(PROMPT_PERCENT) option is set, certain escape sequences that
+start with `tt(%)' are expanded.
+Some escapes take an optional integer argument, which
+should appear between the `tt(%)' and the next character of the
+sequence.  The following escape sequences are recognized:
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(%%))(
+A `tt(%)'.
+)
+item(tt(%RPAR()))(
+A `tt(RPAR())'.
+)
+xitem(tt(%d))
+item(tt(%/))(
+Present working directory (tt($PWD)).
+)
+item(tt(%~))(
+tt($PWD).
+If it has a named directory as its prefix, that part is replaced
+by a `tt(~)' followed by the name of the directory.
+If it starts with tt($HOME), that part is
+replaced by a `tt(~)'.
+)
+xitem(tt(%c))
+xitem(tt(%.))
+item(tt(%C))(
+Trailing component of tt($PWD).
+An integer may follow the `tt(%)' to get more than one component.
+Unless `tt(%C)' is used, tilde contraction is performed first.
+)
+xitem(tt(%h))
+item(tt(%!))(
+Current history event number.
+)
+item(tt(%L))(
+The current value of tt($SHLVL).
+)
+item(tt(%M))(
+The full machine hostname.
+)
+item(tt(%m))(
+The hostname up to the first `tt(.)'.
+An integer may follow the `tt(%)' to specify
+how many components of the hostname are desired.
+)
+item(tt(%S) LPAR()tt(%s)RPAR())(
+Start (stop) standout mode.
+)
+item(tt(%U) LPAR()tt(%u)RPAR())(
+Start (stop) underline mode.
+)
+item(tt(%B) LPAR()tt(%b)RPAR())(
+Start (stop) boldface mode.
+)
+xitem(tt(%t))
+item(tt(%@))(
+Current time of day, in 12-hour, am/pm format.
+)
+item(tt(%T))(
+Current time of day, in 24-hour format.
+)
+item(tt(%*))(
+Current time of day in 24-hour format, with seconds.
+)
+item(tt(%n))(
+tt($USERNAME).
+)
+item(tt(%w))(
+The date in var(day)tt(-)var(dd) format.
+)
+item(tt(%W))(
+The date in var(mm)tt(/)var(dd)tt(/)var(yy) format.
+)
+item(tt(%D))(
+The date in var(yy)tt(-)var(mm)tt(-)var(dd) format.
+)
+item(tt(%D{)var(string)tt(}))(
+var(string) is formatted using the tt(strftime) function.
+See manref(strftime)(3) for more details.  Three additional codes are
+available:  tt(%f) prints the day of the month, like tt(%e) but
+without any preceding space if the day is a single digit, and
+tt(%K)/tt(%L) correspond to tt(%k)/tt(%l) for the hour of the day
+(24/12 hour clock) in the same way.
+)
+item(tt(%l))(
+The line (tty) the user is logged in on.
+)
+item(tt(%?))(
+The return code of the last command executed just before the prompt.
+)
+item(tt(%_))(
+The status of the parser, i.e. the shell constructs (like `tt(if)' and
+`tt(for)') that have been started on the command line. If given an integer
+number that many strings will be printed; zero or no integer means
+print as many as there are.
+)
+item(tt(%E))(
+Clears to end of line.
+)
+item(tt(%#))(
+A `tt(#)' if the shell is running with privileges, a `tt(%)' if not.
+Equivalent to `tt(%(!.#.%%))'.
+The definition of `privileged', for these purposes, is that either the
+effective user ID is zero, or, if POSIX.1e capabilities are supported, that
+at least one capability is raised in either the Effective or Inheritable
+capability vectors.
+)
+item(tt(%v))(
+vindex(psvar, use of)
+The value of the first element of the tt(psvar) array parameter.  Following
+the `tt(%)' with an integer gives that element of the array.
+)
+item(tt(%{)...tt(%}))(
+Include a string as a literal escape sequence.
+The string within the braces should not change the cursor
+position.  Brace pairs can nest.
+)
+item(tt(%LPAR())var(x.true-text.false-text)tt(RPAR()))(
+Specifies a ternary expression.  The character following the var(x) is
+arbitrary; the same character is used to separate the text for the
+`true' result from that for the `false' result.
+This separator may not appear in the var(true-text), except as part of a
+%-escape
+sequence.  A `tt(RPAR())' may appear in the var(false-text) as `tt(%RPAR())'.
+var(true-text)
+and var(false-text) may both contain arbitrarily-nested escape
+sequences, including further ternary expressions.
+
+The left
+parenthesis may be preceded or followed by a positive integer var(n),
+which defaults to zero.  The test character var(x) may be any of the
+following:
+
+startsitem()
+sxitem(tt(c))
+sxitem(tt(.))
+sitem(tt(~))(True if the current path, with prefix replacement, has at least var(n) elements.)
+sxitem(tt(/))
+sitem(tt(C))(True if the current absolute path has at least var(n) elements.)
+sitem(tt(t))(True if the time in minutes is equal to var(n).)
+sitem(tt(T))(True if the time in hours is equal to var(n).)
+sitem(tt(d))(True if the day of the month is equal to var(n).)
+sitem(tt(D))(True if the month is equal to var(n) (January = 0).)
+sitem(tt(w))(True if the day of the week is equal to var(n) (Sunday = 0).)
+sitem(tt(?))(True if the exit status of the last command was var(n).)
+sitem(tt(#))(True if the effective uid of the current process is var(n).)
+sitem(tt(g))(True if the effective gid of the current process is var(n).)
+sitem(tt(L))(True if the tt(SHLVL) parameter is at least var(n).)
+sitem(tt(S))(True if the tt(SECONDS) parameter is at least var(n).)
+sitem(tt(v))(True if the array tt(psvar) has at least var(n) elements.)
+sitem(tt(_))(True if at least var(n) shell constructs were started.)
+sitem(tt(!))(True if the shell is running with privileges.)
+endsitem()
+)
+xitem(tt(%<)var(string)tt(<))
+xitem(tt(%>)var(string)tt(>))
+item(tt(%[)var(xstring)tt(]))(
+Specifies truncation behaviour.
+The third, deprecated, form is equivalent to `tt(%)var(xstringx)',
+i.e. var(x) may be `tt(<)' or `tt(>)'.
+The numeric argument, which in the third form may appear immediately
+after the `tt([)', specifies the maximum permitted length of
+the various strings that can be displayed in the prompt.  If this
+integer is zero, or missing, truncation is disabled.  Truncation is
+initially disabled.
+The var(string) will be displayed in
+place of the truncated portion of any string.
+
+The forms with `tt(<)' truncate at the left of the string,
+and the forms with `tt(>)' truncate at the right of the string.
+For example, if the current directory is `tt(/home/pike)',
+the prompt `tt(%8<..<%/)' will expand to `tt(..e/pike)'.
+In this string, the terminating character (`tt(<)', `tt(>)' or `tt(])'),
+or in fact any character, may be quoted by a preceding `tt(\)'.
+% escapes are em(not) recognised.
+If the var(string) is longer than the specified truncation length,
+it will appear in full, completely replacing the truncated string.
+)
+enditem()
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/redirect.yo b/Doc/Zsh/redirect.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..8955e67ac
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/redirect.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,183 @@
+texinode(Redirection)(Command Execution)(Shell Grammar)(Top)
+chapter(Redirection)
+cindex(redirection)
+ifzman(\
+sect(Redirection)
+)\
+cindex(file descriptors)
+cindex(descriptors, file)
+If a command is followed by tt(&)
+and job control is not active,
+then the default standard input
+for the command is the empty file tt(/dev/null).
+Otherwise, the environment for the execution of a command contains the
+file descriptors of the invoking shell as modified by
+input/output specifications.
+
+The following may appear anywhere in a simple command
+or may precede or follow a complex command.
+Substitution occurs before var(word) or var(digit)
+is used except as noted below.
+If the result of substitution on var(word)
+produces more than one filename,
+redirection occurs for each
+separate filename in turn.
+
+startitem()
+item(tt(<) var(word))(
+Open file var(word) for reading as standard input.
+)
+item(tt(<>) var(word))(
+Open file var(word) for reading and writing as standard input.
+If the file does not exist then it is created.
+)
+item(tt(>) var(word))(
+Open file var(word) for writing as standard output.
+If the file does not exist then it is created.
+If the file exists, and the tt(CLOBBER) option is unset,
+this causes an error;
+otherwise, it is truncated to zero length.
+)
+xitem(tt(>|) var(word))
+item(tt(>!) var(word))(
+Same as tt(>), except that the file is truncated to zero length
+if it exists, even if tt(CLOBBER) is unset.
+)
+item(tt(>>) var(word))(
+Open file var(word) for writing in append mode as standard output.
+If the file does not exist, and the tt(CLOBBER)
+option is unset, this causes an error;
+otherwise, the file is created.
+)
+xitem(tt(>>|) var(word))
+item(tt(>>!) var(word))(
+Same as tt(>>), except that the file is created if it does not
+exist, even if tt(CLOBBER) is unset.
+)
+item(tt(<<)[tt(-)] var(word))(
+The shell input is read up to a line that is the same as
+var(word), or to an end-of-file.
+No parameter substitution, command substitution or
+filename generation is performed on var(word).
+The resulting document, called a
+em(here-document), becomes the standard input.
+
+If any character of var(word) is quoted with
+single or double quotes or a `tt(\)',
+no interpretation is placed upon the characters of the document.
+Otherwise, parameter and command substitution
+occurs, `tt(\)' followed by a newline is removed,
+and `tt(\)' must be used to quote the characters
+`tt(\)', `tt($)', `tt(`)' and the first character of var(word).
+
+If tt(<<-) is used, then all leading
+tabs are stripped from var(word) and from the document.
+)
+item(tt(<<<) var(word))(
+Perform shell expansion on var(word) and pass the result
+to standard input.  This is known as a em(here-string).
+)
+xitem(tt(<&) var(digit))
+item(tt(>&) var(digit))(
+The standard input/output is duplicated from file descriptor
+var(digit) (see manref(dup)(2)).
+)
+xitem(tt(<& -))
+item(tt(>& -))(
+Close the standard input/output.
+)
+xitem(tt(<& p))
+item(tt(>& p))(
+The input/output from/to the coprocess is moved to the standard input/output.
+)
+item(tt(>&) var(word))(
+Same as `tt(>) var(word) tt(2>&1)'.
+)
+item(tt(>>&) var(word))(
+Same as `tt(>>) var(word) tt(2>&1)'.
+)
+enditem()
+
+If one of the above is preceded by a digit, then the file
+descriptor referred to is that specified by the digit
+instead of the default 0 or 1.
+The order in which redirections are specified is significant.
+The shell evaluates each redirection in terms of the
+(em(file descriptor), em(file))
+association at the time of evaluation.
+For example:
+
+nofill(... tt(1>)var(fname) tt(2>&1))
+
+first associates file descriptor 1 with file var(fname).
+It then associates file descriptor 2 with the file associated with file
+descriptor 1 (that is, var(fname)).
+If the order of redirections were reversed,
+file descriptor 2 would be associated
+with the terminal (assuming file descriptor 1 had been)
+and then file descriptor 1 would be associated with file var(fname).
+sect(Multios)
+pindex(MULTIOS, use of)
+If the user tries to open a file descriptor for writing more than once,
+the shell opens the file descriptor as a pipe to a process that copies
+its input to all the specified outputs, similar to bf(tee),
+provided the tt(MULTIOS) option is set.  Thus:
+
+nofill(tt(date >foo >bar))
+
+writes the date to two files, named `tt(foo)' and `tt(bar)'.
+Note that a pipe is an implicit redirection; thus
+
+nofill(tt(date >foo | cat))
+
+writes the date to the file `tt(foo)', and also pipes it to cat.
+
+If the tt(MULTIOS)
+option is set, the word after a redirection operator is also subjected
+to filename generation (globbing).  Thus
+
+nofill(tt(: > *))
+
+will truncate all files in the current directory,
+assuming there's at least one.  (Without the tt(MULTIOS)
+option, it would create an empty file called `tt(*)'.)
+Similarly, you can do
+
+nofill(tt(echo exit 0 >> *.sh))
+
+If the user tries to open a file descriptor for reading more than once,
+the shell opens the file descriptor as a pipe to a process that copies
+all the specified inputs to its output in the order
+specified, similar to bf(cat),
+provided the tt(MULTIOS) option is set.  Thus
+
+nofill(tt(sort <foo <fubar))
+
+or even
+
+nofill(tt(sort <f{oo,ubar}))
+
+is equivalent to `tt(cat foo fubar | sort)'.
+
+Note that a pipe is an implicit redirection; thus
+
+nofill(tt(cat bar | sort <foo))
+
+is equivalent to `tt(cat bar foo | sort)' (note the order of the inputs).
+
+If the tt(MULTIOS) option is em(un)set,
+each redirection replaces the previous redirection for that file descriptor.
+However, all files redirected to are actually opened, so
+
+nofill(tt(echo foo > bar > baz))
+
+when tt(MULTIOS) is unset will truncate bar, and write `tt(foo)' into baz.
+
+If a simple command consists of one or more redirection operators
+and zero or more parameter assignments, but no command name,
+the command named in the shell variable tt(READNULLCMD) is assumed.
+(If tt(READNULLCMD) is empty or not set, `tt(cat)' is used.)  Thus
+
+nofill(tt(< file))
+
+prints the contents of tt(file).
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/restricted.yo b/Doc/Zsh/restricted.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..a61fd4955
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/restricted.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,44 @@
+texinode(Restricted Shell)(Expansion)(Prompt Expansion)(Top)
+chapter(Restricted Shell)
+ifzman(\
+sect(Restricted Shell)
+)\
+cindex(restricted shell)
+pindex(RESTRICTED)
+When the basename of the command used to invoke zsh starts with the letter
+`tt(r)' or the `tt(-r)' command line option is supplied at invocation, the
+shell becomes restricted.  Emulation mode is determined after stripping the
+letter `tt(r)' from the invocation name.  The following are disabled in
+restricted mode:
+
+startitemize()
+itemiz(changing directories with the tt(cd) builtin)
+itemiz(changing or unsetting the tt(PATH), tt(path), tt(MODULE_PATH),
+tt(module_path), tt(SHELL), tt(HISTFILE), tt(HISTSIZE), tt(GID), tt(EGID),
+tt(UID), tt(EUID), tt(USERNAME), tt(LD_LIBRARY_PATH),
+tt(LD_AOUT_LIBRARY_PATH), tt(LD_PRELOAD) and  tt(LD_AOUT_PRELOAD)
+parameters)
+itemiz(specifying command names containing tt(/))
+itemiz(specifying command pathnames using tt(hash))
+itemiz(redirecting output to files)
+itemiz(using the tt(exec) builtin command to replace the shell with another
+command)
+itemiz(using tt(jobs -Z) to overwrite the shell process' argument and
+environment space)
+itemiz(using the tt(ARGV0) parameter to override tt(argv[0]) for external
+commands)
+itemiz(turning off restricted mode with tt(set +r) or tt(unsetopt
+RESTRICTED))
+itemiz(specifying modules to be loaded with an explicitly given
+pathname containing slashes)
+enditemize()
+
+These restrictions are enforced after processing the startup files.  The
+startup files should set up tt(PATH) to point to a directory of commands
+which can be safely invoked in the restricted environment.  They may also
+add further restrictions by disabling selected builtins.
+
+Restricted mode can also be activated any time by setting the
+tt(RESTRICTED) option.  This immediately enables all the restrictions
+described above even if the shell still have not processed all startup
+files.
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/seealso.yo b/Doc/Zsh/seealso.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..8289e6628
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/seealso.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,25 @@
+texinode(See Also)()(The Zsh Web Page)(Introduction)
+sect(See Also)
+manref(sh)(1),
+manref(csh)(1),
+manref(tcsh)(1),
+manref(rc)(1),
+manref(bash)(1),
+manref(ksh)(1)\
+ifzshone(\
+,
+zmanref(zshbuiltins),
+zmanref(zshcompctl),
+zmanref(zshexpn),
+zmanref(zshmisc),
+zmanref(zshmodules),
+zmanref(zshoptions),
+zmanref(zshparam),
+zmanref(zshzle)\
+)\
+
+
+bf(IEEE Standard for information Technology -
+Portable Operating System Interface (POSIX) -
+Part 2: Shell and Utilities),
+IEEE Inc, 1993, ISBN 1-55937-255-9.
diff --git a/Doc/Zsh/zle.yo b/Doc/Zsh/zle.yo
new file mode 100644
index 000000000..fccf538bd
--- /dev/null
+++ b/Doc/Zsh/zle.yo
@@ -0,0 +1,1076 @@
+texinode(Zsh Line Editor)(Programmable Completion)(Shell Builtin Commands)(Top)
+chapter(Zsh Line Editor)
+cindex(line editor)
+cindex(editor, line)
+sect(Description)
+pindex(ZLE, use of)
+If the tt(ZLE) option is set (it is by default)
+and the shell input is attached to the terminal, the user
+is allowed to edit command lines.
+
+There are two display modes.  The first, multiline mode, is the
+default.  It only works if the tt(TERM) parameter is set to a valid
+terminal type that can move the cursor up.  The second, single line
+mode, is used if tt(TERM) is invalid or incapable of moving the
+cursor up, or if the tt(SINGLE_LINE_ZLE) option is set.
+pindex(SINGLE_LINE_ZLE, use of)
+cindex(ksh, editor mode)
+cindex(editor ksh style)
+This mode
+is similar to bf(ksh), and uses no termcap sequences.  If tt(TERM) is
+"emacs", the tt(ZLE) option will be unset by default.
+sect(Keymaps)
+cindex(keymaps)
+cindex(key bindings)
+cindex(bindings, key)
+A keymap in ZLE contains a set of bindings between key sequences
+and ZLE commands.  The empty key sequence cannot be bound.
+
+There can be any number of keymaps at any time, and each keymap has one
+or more names.  If all of a keymap's names are deleted, it disappears.
+findex(bindkey, use of)
+tt(bindkey) can be used to manipulate keymap names.
+
+Initially, there are four keymaps:
+
+startsitem()
+sitem(tt(emacs))(EMACS emulation)
+sitem(tt(viins))(vi emulation - insert mode)
+sitem(tt(vicmd))(vi emulation - command mode)
+sitem(tt(.safe))(fallback keymap)
+endsitem()
+
+The `tt(.safe)' keymap is special.  It can never be altered, and the name
+can never be removed.  However, it can be linked to other names, which can
+be removed.  In the future other special keymaps may be added; users should
+avoid using names beginning with `tt(.)' for their own keymaps.
+
+vindex(VISUAL)
+vindex(EDITOR)
+In addition to these four names, either `tt(emacs)' or `tt(viins)' is
+also linked to the name `tt(main)'.  If one of the tt(VISUAL) or
+tt(EDITOR) environment variables contain the string `tt(vi)' when the shell
+starts up then it will be `tt(viins)', otherwise it will be `tt(emacs)'.
+tt(bindkey)'s tt(-e) and tt(-v)
+options provide a convenient way to override this default choice.
+
+When the editor starts up, it will select the `tt(main)' keymap.
+If that keymap doesn't exist, it will use `tt(.safe)' instead.
+
+In the `tt(.safe)' keymap, each single key is bound to tt(self-insert),
+except for ^J (line feed) and ^M (return) which are bound to tt(accept-line).
+This is deliberately not pleasant to use; if you are using it, it
+means you deleted the main keymap, and you should put it back.
+subsect(Reading Commands)
+When ZLE is reading a command from the terminal, it may read a sequence
+that is bound to some command and is also a prefix of a longer bound string.
+In this case ZLE will wait a certain time to see if more characters
+are typed, and if not (or they don't match any longer string) it will
+execute the binding.  This timeout is defined by the tt(KEYTIMEOUT) parameter;
+its default is 0.4 sec.  No timeout is done if the prefix string is not bound.
+
+As well as ZLE commands, key sequences can be bound to other strings, by using
+`tt(bindkey -s)'.
+When such a sequence is read, the replacement string is pushed back as input,
+and the command reading process starts again using these fake keystrokes.
+This input can itself invoke further replacement strings, but in order to
+detect loops the process will be stopped if there are twenty such replacements
+without a real command being read.
+sect(Widgets)
+cindex(widgets)
+All actions in the editor are performed by `widgets'.  A widget's job is
+simply to perform some small action.  The ZLE commands that key sequences
+in keymaps are bound to are in fact widgets.  Widgets can be user-defined
+or built in.
+
+There are 162 standard widgets built in to ZLE (see sectref(Standard Widgets)).
+Other built-in widgets can be defined by other modules (see
+ifzman(zmanref(zshmodules))\
+ifnzman(noderef(Zsh Modules))\
+).  Each built-in widget has two names: its normal canonical name, and the
+same name preceded by a `tt(.)'.  The `tt(.)' name is special: it can't be
+rebound to a different widget.  This makes the widget available even when
+its usual name has been redefined.
+
+User-defined widgets are defined using `tt(zle -N)', and implemented
+as shell functions.  When the widget is executed, the corresponding
+shell function is executed, and can perform editing (or other) actions.
+It is recommended that user-defined widgets should not have names
+starting with `tt(.)'.
+sect(User-Defined Widgets)
+cindex(widgets, user-defined)
+User-defined widgets, being implemented as shell functions,
+can execute any normal shell command.  They can also run other widgets
+(whether built-in or user-defined) using the tt(zle) builtin command.
+Finally, they can examine and edit the ZLE buffer being edited by
+reading and setting the special parameters described below.
+
+cindex(parameters, editor)
+cindex(parameters, zle)
+These special parameters are always available in widget functions, but
+are not in any way special outside ZLE.  If they have some normal value
+outside ZLE, that value is temporarily inaccessible, but will return
+when the widget function exits.  These special parameters in fact have
+local scope, like parameters created in a function using tt(local).
+
+startitem()
+vindex(BUFFER)
+item(tt(BUFFER) (scalar))(
+The entire contents of the edit buffer.  If it is written to, the
+cursor remains at the same offset, unless that would put it outside the
+buffer.
+)
+vindex(CURSOR)
+item(tt(CURSOR) (integer))(
+The offset of the cursor, within the edit buffer.  This is in the range
+0 to tt($#BUFFER), and is by definition equal to tt($#LBUFFER).
+Attempts to move the cursor outside the buffer will result in the
+cursor being moved to the appropriate end of the buffer.
+)
+vindex(LBUFFER)
+item(tt(LBUFFER) (scalar))(
+The part of the buffer that lies to the left of the cursor position.
+If it is assigned to, only that part of the buffer is replaced, and the
+cursor remains between the new tt($LBUFFER) and the old tt($RBUFFER).
+)
+vindex(RBUFFER)
+item(tt(RBUFFER) (scalar))(
+The part of the buffer that lies to the right of the cursor position.
+If it is assigned to, only that part of the buffer is replaced, and the
+cursor remains between the old tt($LBUFFER) and the new tt($RBUFFER).
+)
+enditem()
+sect(Standard Widgets)
+cindex(widgets, standard)
+The following is a list of all the standard widgets,
+and their default bindings in emacs mode,
+vi command mode and vi insert mode
+(the `tt(emacs)', `tt(vicmd)' and `tt(viins)' keymaps, respectively).
+startmenu()
+menu(Movement)
+menu(History Control)
+menu(Modifying Text)
+menu(Arguments)
+menu(Completion)
+menu(Miscellaneous)
+endmenu()
+texinode(Movement)(History Control)()(Zsh Line Editor)
+subsect(Movement)
+startitem()
+tindex(vi-backward-blank-word)
+item(tt(vi-backward-blank-word) (unbound) (B) (unbound))(
+Move backward one word, where a word is defined as a series of
+non-blank characters.
+)
+tindex(backward-char)
+item(tt(backward-char) (^B ESC-[D) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Move backward one character.
+)
+tindex(vi-backward-char)
+item(tt(vi-backward-char) (unbound) (^H h ^?) (unbound))(
+Move backward one character, without changing lines.
+)
+tindex(backward-word)
+item(tt(backward-word) (ESC-B ESC-b) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Move to the beginning of the previous word.
+)
+tindex(emacs-backward-word)
+item(tt(emacs-backward-word))(
+Move to the beginning of the previous word.
+)
+tindex(vi-backward-word)
+item(tt(vi-backward-word) (unbound) (b) (unbound))(
+Move to the beginning of the previous word, vi-style.
+)
+tindex(beginning-of-line)
+item(tt(beginning-of-line) (^A) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Move to the beginning of the line.  If already at the beginning
+of the line, move to the beginning of the previous line, if any.
+)
+tindex(vi-beginning-of-line)
+item(tt(vi-beginning-of-line))(
+Move to the beginning of the line, without changing lines.
+)
+tindex(end-of-line)
+item(tt(end-of-line) (^E) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Move to the end of the line.  If already at the end
+of the line, move to the end of the next line, if any.
+)
+tindex(vi-end-of-line)
+item(tt(vi-end-of-line) (unbound) ($) (unbound))(
+Move to the end of the line.
+If an argument is given to this command, the cursor will be moved to
+the end of the line (argument - 1) lines down.
+)
+tindex(vi-forward-blank-word)
+item(tt(vi-forward-blank-word) (unbound) (W) (unbound))(
+Move forward one word, where a word is defined as a series of
+non-blank characters.
+)
+tindex(vi-forward-blank-word-end)
+item(tt(vi-forward-blank-word-end) (unbound) (E) (unbound))(
+Move to the end of the current word, or, if at the end of the current word,
+to the end of the next word,
+where a word is defined as a series of non-blank characters.
+)
+tindex(forward-char)
+item(tt(forward-char) (^F ESC-[C) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Move forward one character.
+)
+tindex(vi-forward-char)
+item(tt(vi-forward-char) (unbound) (space l) (unbound))(
+Move forward one character.
+)
+tindex(vi-find-next-char)
+item(tt(vi-find-next-char) (^X^F) (f) (unbound))(
+Read a character from the keyboard, and move to
+the next occurrence of it in the line.
+)
+tindex(vi-find-next-char-skip)
+item(tt(vi-find-next-char-skip) (unbound) (t) (unbound))(
+Read a character from the keyboard, and move to
+the position just before the next occurrence of it in the line.
+)
+tindex(vi-find-prev-char)
+item(tt(vi-find-prev-char) (unbound) (F) (unbound))(
+Read a character from the keyboard, and move to
+the previous occurrence of it in the line.
+)
+tindex(vi-find-prev-char-skip)
+item(tt(vi-find-prev-char-skip) (unbound) (T) (unbound))(
+Read a character from the keyboard, and move to
+the position just after the previous occurrence of it in the line.
+)
+tindex(vi-first-non-blank)
+item(tt(vi-first-non-blank) (unbound) (^) (unbound))(
+Move to the first non-blank character in the line.
+)
+tindex(vi-forward-word)
+item(tt(vi-forward-word) (unbound) (w) (unbound))(
+Move forward one word, vi-style.
+)
+tindex(forward-word)
+item(tt(forward-word) (ESC-F ESC-f) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Move to the beginning of the next word.
+The editor's idea of a word is specified with the tt(WORDCHARS)
+parameter.
+)
+tindex(emacs-forward-word)
+item(tt(emacs-forward-word))(
+Move to the end of the next word.
+)
+tindex(vi-forward-word-end)
+item(tt(vi-forward-word-end) (unbound) (e) (unbound))(
+Move to the end of the next word.
+)
+tindex(vi-goto-column)
+item(tt(vi-goto-column) (ESC-|) (|) (unbound))(
+Move to the column specified by the numeric argument.
+)
+tindex(vi-goto-mark)
+item(tt(vi-goto-mark) (unbound) (`) (unbound))(
+Move to the specified mark.
+)
+tindex(vi-goto-mark-line)
+item(tt(vi-goto-mark-line) (unbound) (') (unbound))(
+Move to beginning of the line containing the specified mark.
+)
+tindex(vi-repeat-find)
+item(tt(vi-repeat-find) (unbound) (;) (unbound))(
+Repeat the last tt(vi-find) command.
+)
+tindex(vi-rev-repeat-find)
+item(tt(vi-rev-repeat-find) (unbound) (,) (unbound))(
+Repeat the last tt(vi-find) command in the opposite direction.
+)
+enditem()
+texinode(History Control)(Modifying Text)(Movement)(Zsh Line Editor)
+subsect(History Control)
+startitem()
+tindex(beginning-of-buffer-or-history)
+item(tt(beginning-of-buffer-or-history) (ESC-<) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Move to the beginning of the buffer, or if already there,
+move to the first event in the history list.
+)
+tindex(beginning-of-line-hist)
+item(tt(beginning-of-line-hist))(
+Move to the beginning of the line.  If already at the
+beginning of the buffer, move to the previous history line.
+)
+tindex(beginning-of-history)
+item(tt(beginning-of-history))(
+Move to the first event in the history list.
+)
+tindex(down-line-or-history)
+item(tt(down-line-or-history) (^N ESC-[B) (j) (unbound))(
+Move down a line in the buffer, or if already at the bottom line,
+move to the next event in the history list.
+)
+tindex(vi-down-line-or-history)
+item(tt(vi-down-line-or-history) (unbound) (PLUS()) (unbound))(
+Move down a line in the buffer, or if already at the bottom line,
+move to the next event in the history list.
+Then move to the first non-blank character on the line.
+)
+tindex(down-line-or-search)
+item(tt(down-line-or-search))(
+Move down a line in the buffer, or if already at the bottom line,
+search forward in the history for a line beginning with the first
+word in the buffer.
+)
+tindex(down-history)
+item(tt(down-history) (unbound) (^N) (unbound))(
+Move to the next event in the history list.
+)
+tindex(history-beginning-search-backward)
+item(tt(history-beginning-search-backward))(
+Search backward in the history for a line beginning with the current
+line up to the cursor.
+This leaves the cursor in its original position.
+)
+tindex(end-of-buffer-or-history)
+item(tt(end-of-buffer-or-history) (ESC->) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Move to the end of the buffer, or if already there,
+move to the last event in the history list.
+)
+tindex(end-of-line-hist)
+item(tt(end-of-line-hist))(
+Move to the end of the line.  If already at the end of
+the buffer, move to the next history line.
+)
+tindex(end-of-history)
+item(tt(end-of-history))(
+Move to the last event in the history list.
+)
+tindex(vi-fetch-history)
+item(tt(vi-fetch-history) (unbound) (G) (unbound))(
+Fetch the history line specified by the numeric argument.
+This defaults to the current history line
+(i.e. the one that isn't history yet).
+)
+tindex(history-incremental-search-backward)
+item(tt(history-incremental-search-backward) (^R ^Xr) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Search backward incrementally for a specified string.  The search is
+case-insensitive if the search string does not have uppercase letters and no
+numeric argument was given.  The string may begin with `tt(^)' to anchor the
+search to the beginning of the line.
+
+A restricted set of editing functions
+is available in the mini-buffer.  An interrupt signal, as defined by the stty
+setting, will stop the search and go back to the original line.  An undefined
+key will have the same effect. The supported functions are:
+tt(backward-delete-char),
+tt(vi-backward-delete-char),
+tt(clear-screen),
+tt(redisplay),
+tt(quoted-insert),
+tt(vi-quoted-insert),
+tt(accept-and-hold),
+tt(accept-and-infer-next-history),
+tt(accept-line) and
+tt(accept-line-and-down-history).
+
+tt(magic-space) just inserts a space.
+tt(vi-cmd-mode) toggles between the `tt(main)' and `tt(vicmd)' keymaps;
+the `tt(main)' keymap (insert mode) will be selected initially.
+tt(history-incremental-search-backward) will get the
+next occurrence of the contents of the mini-buffer.
+tt(history-incremental-search-forward) inverts the sense of the search.
+tt(vi-repeat-search) and tt(vi-rev-repeat-search) are similarly supported.
+The direction of the search is indicated in the mini-buffer.
+
+Any multi-character string
+that is not bound to one of the above functions will beep and interrupt the
+search, leaving the last found line in the buffer. Any single character that
+is not bound to one of the above functions, or tt(self-insert) or
+tt(self-insert-unmeta), will have the same effect but the function will be
+executed.
+)
+tindex(history-incremental-search-forward)
+item(tt(history-incremental-search-forward) (^S ^Xs) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Search forward incrementally for a specified string.  The search is
+case-insensitive if the search string does not have uppercase letters and no
+numeric argument was given.  The string may begin with `tt(^)' to anchor the
+search to the beginning of the line.  The functions available in the
+mini-buffer are the same as for tt(history-incremental-search-backward).
+)
+tindex(history-search-backward)
+item(tt(history-search-backward) (ESC-P ESC-p) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Search backward in the history for a line beginning with the first
+word in the buffer.
+)
+tindex(vi-history-search-backward)
+item(tt(vi-history-search-backward) (unbound) (/) (unbound))(
+Search backward in the history for a specified string.
+The string may begin with `tt(^)' to anchor the search to the
+beginning of the line.
+
+A restricted set of editing functions is available in
+the mini-buffer.  An interrupt signal, as defined by the stty setting,  will
+stop the search.
+The functions available in the mini-buffer are:
+tt(accept-line),
+tt(backward-delete-char),
+tt(vi-backward-delete-char),
+tt(backward-kill-word),
+tt(vi-backward-kill-word),
+tt(clear-screen),
+tt(redisplay),
+tt(quoted-insert)
+and
+tt(vi-quoted-insert).
+
+tt(vi-cmd-mode) is treated the same as accept-line, and
+tt(magic-space) is treated as a space.
+Any other character that is not bound to self-insert or
+self-insert-unmeta will beep and be ignored. If the function is called from vi
+command mode, the bindings of the current insert mode will be used.
+)
+tindex(history-search-forward)
+item(tt(history-search-forward) (ESC-N ESC-n) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Search forward in the history for a line beginning with the first
+word in the buffer.
+)
+tindex(vi-history-search-forward)
+item(tt(vi-history-search-forward) (unbound) (?) (unbound))(
+Search forward in the history for a specified string.
+The string may begin with `tt(^)' to anchor the search to the
+beginning of the line. The functions available in the mini-buffer are the same
+as for tt(vi-history-search-backward).
+)
+tindex(infer-next-history)
+item(tt(infer-next-history) (^X^N) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Search in the history list for a line matching the current one and
+fetch the event following it.
+)
+tindex(insert-last-word)
+item(tt(insert-last-word) (ESC-_ ESC-.) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Insert the last word from the previous history event at the
+cursor position.  If a positive numeric argument is given,
+insert that word from the end of the previous history event.
+If the argument is zero or negative insert that word from the
+left (zero inserts the previous command word).
+)
+tindex(vi-repeat-search)
+item(tt(vi-repeat-search) (unbound) (n) (unbound))(
+Repeat the last vi history search.
+)
+tindex(vi-rev-repeat-search)
+item(tt(vi-rev-repeat-search) (unbound) (N) (unbound))(
+Repeat the last vi history search, but in reverse.
+)
+tindex(up-line-or-history)
+item(tt(up-line-or-history) (^P ESC-[A) (k) (unbound))(
+Move up a line in the buffer, or if already at the top line,
+move to the previous event in the history list.
+)
+tindex(vi-up-line-or-history)
+item(tt(vi-up-line-or-history) (unbound) (-) (unbound))(
+Move up a line in the buffer, or if already at the top line,
+move to the previous event in the history list.
+Then move to the first non-blank character on the line.
+)
+tindex(up-line-or-search)
+item(tt(up-line-or-search))(
+Move up a line in the buffer, or if already at the top line,
+search backward in the history for a line beginning with the
+first word in the buffer.
+)
+tindex(up-history)
+item(tt(up-history) (unbound) (^P) (unbound))(
+Move to the previous event in the history list.
+)
+tindex(history-beginning-search-forward)
+item(tt(history-beginning-search-forward))(
+Search forward in the history for a line beginning with the current
+line up to the cursor.
+This leaves the cursor in its original position.
+)
+enditem()
+texinode(Modifying Text)(Arguments)(History Control)(Zsh Line Editor)
+subsect(Modifying Text)
+startitem()
+tindex(vi-add-eol)
+item(tt(vi-add-eol) (unbound) (A) (unbound))(
+Move to the end of the line and enter insert mode.
+)
+tindex(vi-add-next)
+item(tt(vi-add-next) (unbound) (a) (unbound))(
+Enter insert mode after the current cursor position, without changing lines.
+)
+tindex(backward-delete-char)
+item(tt(backward-delete-char) (^H ^?) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Delete the character behind the cursor.
+)
+tindex(vi-backward-delete-char)
+item(tt(vi-backward-delete-char) (unbound) (X) (^H))(
+Delete the character behind the cursor, without changing lines.
+If in insert mode, this won't delete past the point where insert mode was
+last entered.
+)
+tindex(backward-delete-word)
+item(tt(backward-delete-word))(
+Delete the word behind the cursor.
+)
+tindex(backward-kill-line)
+item(tt(backward-kill-line))(
+Kill from the beginning of the line to the cursor position.
+)
+tindex(backward-kill-word)
+item(tt(backward-kill-word) (^W ESC-^H ESC-^?) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Kill the word behind the cursor.
+)
+tindex(vi-backward-kill-word)
+item(tt(vi-backward-kill-word) (unbound) (unbound) (^W))(
+Kill the word behind the cursor, without going past the point where insert
+mode was last entered.
+)
+tindex(capitalize-word)
+item(tt(capitalize-word) (ESC-C ESC-c) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Capitalize the current word and move past it.
+)
+tindex(vi-change)
+item(tt(vi-change) (unbound) (c) (unbound))(
+Read a movement command from the keyboard, and kill
+from the cursor position to the endpoint of the movement.
+Then enter insert mode.
+If the command is tt(vi-change), change the current line.
+)
+tindex(vi-change-eol)
+item(tt(vi-change-eol) (unbound) (C) (unbound))(
+Kill to the end of the line and enter insert mode.
+)
+tindex(vi-change-whole-line)
+item(tt(vi-change-whole-line) (unbound) (S) (unbound))(
+Kill the current line and enter insert mode.
+)
+tindex(copy-region-as-kill)
+item(tt(copy-region-as-kill) (ESC-W ESC-w) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Copy the area from the cursor to the mark to the kill buffer.
+)
+tindex(copy-prev-word)
+item(tt(copy-prev-word) (ESC-^_) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Duplicate the word behind the cursor.
+)
+tindex(vi-delete)
+item(tt(vi-delete) (unbound) (d) (unbound))(
+Read a movement command from the keyboard, and kill
+from the cursor position to the endpoint of the movement.
+If the command is tt(vi-delete), kill the current line.
+)
+tindex(delete-char)
+item(tt(delete-char))(
+Delete the character under the cursor.
+)
+tindex(vi-delete-char)
+item(tt(vi-delete-char) (unbound) (x) (unbound))(
+Delete the character under the cursor,
+without going past the end of the line.
+)
+tindex(delete-word)
+item(tt(delete-word))(
+Delete the current word.
+)
+tindex(down-case-word)
+item(tt(down-case-word) (ESC-L ESC-l) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Convert the current word to all lowercase and move past it.
+)
+tindex(kill-word)
+item(tt(kill-word) (ESC-D ESC-d) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Kill the current word.
+)
+tindex(gosmacs-transpose-chars)
+item(tt(gosmacs-transpose-chars))(
+Exchange the two characters behind the cursor.
+)
+tindex(vi-indent)
+item(tt(vi-indent) (unbound) (>) (unbound))(
+Indent a number of lines.
+)
+tindex(vi-insert)
+item(tt(vi-insert) (unbound) (i) (unbound))(
+Enter insert mode.
+)
+tindex(vi-insert-bol)
+item(tt(vi-insert-bol) (unbound) (I) (unbound))(
+Move to the first non-blank character on the line and enter insert mode.
+)
+tindex(vi-join)
+item(tt(vi-join) (^X^J) (J) (unbound))(
+Join the current line with the next one.
+)
+tindex(kill-line)
+item(tt(kill-line) (^K) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Kill from the cursor to the end of the line.
+If already on the end of the line, kill the newline character.
+)
+tindex(vi-kill-line)
+item(tt(vi-kill-line) (unbound) (unbound) (^U))(
+Kill from the cursor back to wherever insert mode was last entered.
+)
+tindex(vi-kill-eol)
+item(tt(vi-kill-eol) (unbound) (D) (unbound))(
+Kill from the cursor to the end of the line.
+)
+tindex(kill-region)
+item(tt(kill-region))(
+Kill from the cursor to the mark.
+)
+tindex(kill-buffer)
+item(tt(kill-buffer) (^X^K) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Kill the entire buffer.
+)
+tindex(kill-whole-line)
+item(tt(kill-whole-line) (^U) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Kill the current line.
+)
+tindex(vi-match-bracket)
+item(tt(vi-match-bracket) (^X^B) (%) (unbound))(
+Move to the bracket character (one of tt({}), tt(()) or tt([])) that
+matches the one under the cursor.
+If the cursor is not on a bracket character, move forward without going
+past the end of the line to find one, and then go to the matching bracket.
+)
+tindex(vi-open-line-above)
+item(tt(vi-open-line-above) (unbound) (O) (unbound))(
+Open a line above the cursor and enter insert mode.
+)
+tindex(vi-open-line-below)
+item(tt(vi-open-line-below) (unbound) (o) (unbound))(
+Open a line below the cursor and enter insert mode.
+)
+tindex(vi-oper-swap-case)
+item(tt(vi-oper-swap-case))(
+Read a movement command from the keyboard, and swap
+the case of all characters
+from the cursor position to the endpoint of the movement.
+If the movement command is tt(vi-oper-swap-case),
+swap the case of all characters on the current line.
+)
+tindex(overwrite-mode)
+item(tt(overwrite-mode) (^X^O) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Toggle between overwrite mode and insert mode.
+)
+tindex(vi-put-before)
+item(tt(vi-put-before) (unbound) (P) (unbound))(
+Insert the contents of the kill buffer before the cursor.
+If the kill buffer contains a sequence of lines (as opposed to characters),
+paste it above the current line.
+)
+tindex(vi-put-after)
+item(tt(vi-put-after) (unbound) (p) (unbound))(
+Insert the contents of the kill buffer after the cursor.
+If the kill buffer contains a sequence of lines (as opposed to characters),
+paste it below the current line.
+)
+tindex(quoted-insert)
+item(tt(quoted-insert) (^V) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Insert the next character typed into the buffer literally.
+An interrupt character will not be inserted.
+)
+tindex(vi-quoted-insert)
+item(tt(vi-quoted-insert) (unbound) (unbound) (^Q ^V))(
+Display a `tt(^)' at the cursor position, and
+insert the next character typed into the buffer literally.
+An interrupt character will not be inserted.
+)
+tindex(quote-line)
+item(tt(quote-line) (ESC-') (unbound) (unbound))(
+Quote the current line; that is, put a `tt(')' character at the
+beginning and the end, and convert all `tt(')' characters
+to `tt('\'')'.
+)
+tindex(quote-region)
+item(tt(quote-region) (ESC-") (unbound) (unbound))(
+Quote the region from the cursor to the mark.
+)
+tindex(vi-replace)
+item(tt(vi-replace) (unbound) (R) (unbound))(
+Enter overwrite mode.
+)
+tindex(vi-repeat-change)
+item(tt(vi-repeat-change) (unbound) (.) (unbound))(
+Repeat the last vi mode text modification.
+If a count was used with the modification, it is remembered.
+If a count is given to this command, it overrides the remembered count,
+and is remembered for future uses of this command.
+The cut buffer specification is similarly remembered.
+)
+tindex(vi-replace-chars)
+item(tt(vi-replace-chars) (unbound) (r) (unbound))(
+Replace the character under the cursor with a character
+read from the keyboard.
+)
+tindex(self-insert)
+item(tt(self-insert) (printable characters) (unbound) (printable characters and some control characters))(
+Insert a character into the buffer at the cursor position.
+)
+tindex(self-insert-unmeta)
+item(tt(self-insert-unmeta) (ESC-^I ESC-^J ESC-^M) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Insert a character into the buffer after stripping the meta bit
+and converting ^M to ^J.
+)
+tindex(vi-substitute)
+item(tt(vi-substitute) (unbound) (s) (unbound))(
+Substitute the next characte+CHAR(r)(s).
+)
+tindex(vi-swap-case)
+item(tt(vi-swap-case) (unbound) (~) (unbound))(
+Swap the case of the character under the cursor and move past it.
+)
+tindex(transpose-chars)
+item(tt(transpose-chars) (^T) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Exchange the two characters to the left of the
+cursor if at end of line, else exchange the
+character under the cursor with the character
+to the left.
+)
+tindex(transpose-words)
+item(tt(transpose-words) (ESC-T ESC-t) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Exchange the current word with the one before it.
+)
+tindex(vi-unindent)
+item(tt(vi-unindent) (unbound) (<) (unbound))(
+Unindent a number of lines.
+)
+tindex(up-case-word)
+item(tt(up-case-word) (ESC-U ESC-u) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Convert the current word to all caps and move past it.
+)
+tindex(yank)
+item(tt(yank) (^Y) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Insert the contents of the kill buffer at the cursor position.
+)
+tindex(yank-pop)
+item(tt(yank-pop) (ESC-y) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Remove the text just yanked, rotate the kill-ring,
+and yank the new top.  Only works following
+tt(yank) or tt(yank-pop).
+)
+tindex(vi-yank)
+item(tt(vi-yank) (unbound) (y) (unbound))(
+Read a movement command from the keyboard, and copy the region
+from the cursor position to the endpoint of the movement
+into the kill buffer.
+If the command is tt(vi-yank), copy the current line.
+)
+tindex(vi-yank-whole-line)
+item(tt(vi-yank-whole-line) (unbound) (Y) (unbound))(
+Copy the current line into the kill buffer.
+)
+tindex(vi-yank-eol)
+item(tt(vi-yank-eol))(
+Copy the region from the cursor position to the end of the line
+into the kill buffer.
+Arguably, this is what Y should do in vi, but it isn't what it actually does.
+)
+enditem()
+texinode(Arguments)(Completion)(Modifying Text)(Zsh Line Editor)
+subsect(Arguments)
+startitem()
+tindex(digit-argument)
+item(tt(digit-argument) (ESC-0..ESC-9) (1-9) (unbound))(
+Start a new numeric argument, or add to the current one.
+See also tt(vi-digit-or-beginning-of-line).
+)
+tindex(neg-argument)
+item(tt(neg-argument) (ESC--) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Changes the sign of the following argument.
+)
+tindex(universal-argument)
+item(tt(universal-argument))(
+Multiply the argument of the next command by 4.  Alternatively, if
+this command is followed by an integer (positive or negative), use
+that as the argument for the next command.  Thus digits cannot be
+repeated using this command.  For example, if this command occurs
+twice, followed immediately by tt(forward-char), move forward sixteen
+spaces; if instead it is followed by tt(-2), then tt(forward-char),
+move backward two spaces.
+)
+enditem()
+texinode(Completion)(Miscellaneous)(Arguments)(Zsh Line Editor)
+subsect(Completion)
+startitem()
+tindex(accept-and-menu-complete)
+item(tt(accept-and-menu-complete))(
+In a menu completion, insert the current completion into the buffer,
+and advance to the next possible completion.
+)
+tindex(complete-word)
+item(tt(complete-word))(
+Attempt completion on the current word.
+)
+tindex(delete-char-or-list)
+item(tt(delete-char-or-list) (^D) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Delete the character under the cursor.  If the cursor
+is at the end of the line, list possible completions for the
+current word.
+)
+tindex(expand-cmd-path)
+item(tt(expand-cmd-path))(
+Expand the current command to its full pathname.
+)
+tindex(expand-or-complete)
+item(tt(expand-or-complete) (TAB) (unbound) (TAB))(
+Attempt shell expansion on the current word.
+If that fails,
+attempt completion.
+)
+tindex(expand-or-complete-prefix)
+item(tt(expand-or-complete-prefix))(
+Attempt shell expansion on the current word up to cursor.
+)
+tindex(expand-history)
+item(tt(expand-history) (ESC-space ESC-!) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Perform history expansion on the edit buffer.
+)
+tindex(expand-word)
+item(tt(expand-word) (^X*) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Attempt shell expansion on the current word.
+)
+tindex(list-choices)
+item(tt(list-choices) (ESC-^D) (^D =) (^D))(
+List possible completions for the current word.
+)
+tindex(list-expand)
+item(tt(list-expand) (^Xg ^XG) (^G) (^G))(
+List the expansion of the current word.
+)
+tindex(magic-space)
+item(tt(magic-space))(
+Perform history expansion and insert a space into the
+buffer.  This is intended to be bound to space.
+)
+tindex(menu-complete)
+pindex(MENU_COMPLETE, use of)
+item(tt(menu-complete))(
+Like tt(complete-word), except that menu completion is used.
+See the tt(MENU_COMPLETE) option.
+)
+tindex(menu-expand-or-complete)
+item(tt(menu-expand-or-complete))(
+Like tt(expand-or-complete), except that menu completion is used.
+)
+tindex(reverse-menu-complete)
+item(tt(reverse-menu-complete))(
+Perform menu completion, like tt(menu-complete), except that if
+a menu completion is already in progress, move to the em(previous)
+completion rather than the next.
+)
+enditem()
+texinode(Miscellaneous)()(Completion)(Zsh Line Editor)
+subsect(Miscellaneous)
+startitem()
+tindex(accept-and-hold)
+item(tt(accept-and-hold) (ESC-A ESC-a) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Push the contents of the buffer on the buffer stack
+and execute it.
+)
+tindex(accept-and-infer-next-history)
+item(tt(accept-and-infer-next-history))(
+Execute the contents of the buffer.
+Then search the history list for a line matching the current one
+and push the event following onto the buffer stack.
+)
+tindex(accept-line)
+item(tt(accept-line) (^J ^M) (^J ^M) (^J ^M))(
+Finish editing the buffer.  Normally this causes the buffer to be
+executed as a shell command.
+)
+tindex(accept-line-and-down-history)
+item(tt(accept-line-and-down-history) (^O) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Execute the current line, and push the next history
+event on the the buffer stack.
+)
+tindex(vi-cmd-mode)
+item(tt(vi-cmd-mode) (^X^V) (unbound) (^[))(
+Enter command mode; that is, select the `tt(vicmd)' keymap.
+Yes, this is bound by default in emacs mode.
+)
+tindex(vi-caps-lock-panic)
+item(tt(vi-caps-lock-panic))(
+Hang until any lowercase key is pressed.
+This is for vi users without the mental capacity to keep
+track of their caps lock key (like the author).
+)
+tindex(clear-screen)
+item(tt(clear-screen) (^L ESC-^L) (^L) (^L))(
+Clear the screen and redraw the prompt.
+)
+tindex(describe-key-briefly)
+item(tt(describe-key-briefly))(
+Reads a key sequence, then prints the function bound to that sequence.
+)
+tindex(exchange-point-and-mark)
+item(tt(exchange-point-and-mark) (^X^X) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Exchange the cursor position with the position of the mark.
+)
+tindex(execute-named-cmd)
+item(tt(execute-named-cmd) (ESC-x) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Read the name of an editor command and
+execute it.  A restricted set of editing functions is available in the
+mini-buffer.  An interrupt signal, as defined by the stty setting, will
+abort the function. The allowed functions are:
+tt(backward-delete-char),
+tt(vi-backward-delete-char),
+tt(clear-screen),
+tt(redisplay),
+tt(quoted-insert),
+tt(vi-quoted-insert),
+tt(backward-kill-word),
+tt(vi-backward-kill-word),
+tt(kill-whole-line),
+tt(vi-kill-line),
+tt(backward-kill-line),
+tt(list-choices),
+tt(delete-char-or-list),
+tt(complete-word),
+tt(accept-line),
+tt(expand-or-complete) and
+tt(expand-or-complete-prefix).
+
+tt(kill-region) kills the last word,
+and vi-cmd-mode is treated the same as accept-line.
+The space and tab characters, if not bound to one of
+these functions, will complete the name and then list the
+possibilities if the tt(AUTO_LIST) option is set.
+Any other character that is not bound to tt(self-insert) or
+tt(self-insert-unmeta) will beep and be ignored.
+The bindings of the current insert mode will be used.
+)
+tindex(execute-last-named-cmd)
+item(tt(execute-last-named-cmd) (ESC-z) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Redo the last function executed with tt(execute-named-cmd).
+)
+tindex(get-line)
+item(tt(get-line) (ESC-G ESC-g) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Pop the top line off the buffer stack and insert it at the
+cursor position.
+)
+tindex(pound-insert)
+item(tt(pound-insert) (unbound) (#) (unbound))(
+If there is no # character at the beginning of the buffer,
+add one to the beginning of each line.
+If there is one, remove a # from each line that has one.
+In either case, accept the current line.
+The tt(INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS) option must be set
+for this to have any usefulness.
+)
+tindex(vi-pound-insert)
+item(tt(vi-pound-insert))(
+If there is no # character at the beginning of the current line,
+add one.  If there is one, remove it.
+The tt(INTERACTIVE_COMMENTS) option must be set
+for this to have any usefulness.
+)
+tindex(push-input)
+item(tt(push-input))(
+Push the entire current multiline construct onto the buffer stack and
+return to the top-level (tt(PS1)) prompt.
+If the current parser construct is only a single line, this is exactly
+like tt(push-line).
+Next time the editor starts up or is popped with tt(get-line), the
+construct will be popped off the top of the buffer stack and loaded
+into the editing buffer.
+)
+tindex(push-line)
+item(tt(push-line) (^Q ESC-Q ESC-q) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Push the current buffer onto the buffer stack and clear
+the buffer.
+Next time the editor starts up, the buffer will be popped
+off the top of the buffer stack and loaded into the editing
+buffer.
+)
+tindex(push-line-or-edit)
+item(tt(push-line-or-edit))(
+At the top-level (tt(PS1)) prompt, equivalent to tt(push-line).
+At a secondary (tt(PS2)) prompt, move the entire current multiline
+construct into the editor buffer.
+The latter is equivalent to tt(push-input) followed by tt(get-line).
+)
+tindex(redisplay)
+item(tt(redisplay) (unbound) (^R) (^R))(
+Redisplays the edit buffer.
+)
+tindex(send-break)
+item(tt(send-break) (^G ESC-^G) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Abort the current editor function, e.g. tt(execute-named-command), or the
+editor itself, e.g. if you are in tt(vared). Otherwise abort the parsing of
+the current line.
+)
+tindex(run-help)
+item(tt(run-help) (ESC-H ESC-h) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Push the buffer onto the buffer stack, and execute the
+command `tt(run-help) var(cmd)', where var(cmd) is the current
+command.  tt(run-help) is normally aliased to var(man).
+)
+tindex(vi-set-buffer)
+item(tt(vi-set-buffer) (unbound) (") (unbound))(
+Specify a buffer to be used in the following command.
+There are 35 buffers that can be specified:
+the 26 `named' buffers tt("a) to tt("z)
+and the nine `queued' buffers tt("1) to tt("9).  The named buffers can also
+be specified as tt("A) to tt("Z).
+
+When a buffer is specified for a cut command, the text being cut replaces
+the previous contents of the specified buffer.  If a named buffer
+is specified using a capital, the newly cut text is appended to the buffer
+instead of overwriting it.
+
+If no buffer is specified for a cut command, tt("1) is used, and the
+contents of tt("1) to tt("8) are each shifted along one buffer; the contents of
+tt("9) is lost.
+)
+tindex(vi-set-mark)
+item(tt(vi-set-mark) (unbound) (m) (unbound))(
+Set the specified mark at the cursor position.
+)
+tindex(set-mark-command)
+item(tt(set-mark-command) (^@) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Set the mark at the cursor position.
+)
+tindex(spell-word)
+item(tt(spell-word) (ESC-$ ESC-S ESC-s) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Attempt spelling correction on the current word.
+)
+tindex(undefined-key)
+item(tt(undefined-key))(
+This command is executed when a key sequence that is not bound to any
+command is typed.  By default it beeps.
+)
+tindex(undo)
+item(tt(undo) (^_ ^Xu ^X^U) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Incrementally undo the last text modification.
+)
+tindex(redo)
+item(tt(redo))(
+Incrementally redo undone text modifications.
+)
+tindex(vi-undo-change)
+item(tt(vi-undo-change) (unbound) (u) (unbound))(
+Undo the last text modification.
+If repeated, redo the modification.
+)
+tindex(what-cursor-position)
+item(tt(what-cursor-position) (^X=) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Print the character under the cursor, its code as an octal, decimal and
+hexadecimal number, the current cursor position within the buffer and the
+column of the cursor in the current line.
+)
+tindex(where-is)
+item(tt(where-is))(
+Read the name of an editor command and and print the listing of key
+sequences that invoke the specified command.
+)
+tindex(which-command)
+item(tt(which-command) (ESC-?) (unbound) (unbound))(
+Push the buffer onto the buffer stack, and execute the
+command `tt(which-command) var(cmd)'. where var(cmd) is the current
+command.  tt(which-command) is normally aliased to var(whence).
+)
+tindex(vi-digit-or-beginning-of-line)
+item(tt(vi-digit-or-beginning-of-line) (unbound) (0) (unbound))(
+If the last command executed was a digit as part of an argument,
+continue the argument.  Otherwise, execute vi-beginning-of-line.
+)
+enditem()